elf: Set p_memsz to p_filesz for loadable PT_NOTE segment
[binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf.c
1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /*
24 SECTION
25 ELF backends
26
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
30
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
34
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
36 #define _SYSCALL32
37 #include "sysdep.h"
38 #include <limits.h>
39 #include "bfd.h"
40 #include "bfdlink.h"
41 #include "libbfd.h"
42 #define ARCH_SIZE 0
43 #include "elf-bfd.h"
44 #include "libiberty.h"
45 #include "safe-ctype.h"
46 #include "elf-linux-core.h"
47
48 #ifdef CORE_HEADER
49 #include CORE_HEADER
50 #endif
51
52 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
53 static bool assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
54 static bool swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int,
55 struct bfd_link_info *);
56 static bool elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
57 file_ptr offset, size_t align);
58
59 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
60 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
61 need to move into elfcode.h. */
62
63 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
64
65 void
66 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
67 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
68 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
69 {
70 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
71 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
72 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
73 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
74 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
75 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
76 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
77 }
78
79 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
80
81 void
82 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
83 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
84 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
85 {
86 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
89 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
90 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
92 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
93 }
94
95 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
96
97 void
98 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
99 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
100 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
101 {
102 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
103 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
104 }
105
106 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
107
108 void
109 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
110 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
111 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
112 {
113 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
114 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
115 }
116
117 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
118
119 void
120 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
121 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
122 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
123 {
124 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
125 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
126 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
127 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
128 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
129 }
130
131 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
132
133 void
134 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
135 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
136 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
137 {
138 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
139 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
140 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
142 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
143 }
144
145 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
146
147 void
148 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
149 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
150 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
151 {
152 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
153 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
154 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
155 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
156 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
157 }
158
159 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
160
161 void
162 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
163 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
164 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
165 {
166 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
167 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
168 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
169 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
170 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
171 }
172
173 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
174
175 void
176 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
177 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
178 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
179 {
180 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
181 }
182
183 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
184
185 void
186 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
187 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
188 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
189 {
190 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
191 }
192
193 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
194 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
195
196 unsigned long
197 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
198 {
199 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
200 unsigned long h = 0;
201 unsigned long g;
202 int ch;
203
204 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
205 {
206 h = (h << 4) + ch;
207 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
208 {
209 h ^= g >> 24;
210 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
211 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
212 h ^= g;
213 }
214 }
215 return h & 0xffffffff;
216 }
217
218 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
219 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
220
221 unsigned long
222 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
223 {
224 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
225 unsigned long h = 5381;
226 unsigned char ch;
227
228 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
229 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
230 return h & 0xffffffff;
231 }
232
233 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
234 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
235 bool
236 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
237 size_t object_size,
238 enum elf_target_id object_id)
239 {
240 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
241 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
242 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
243 return false;
244
245 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
246 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
247 {
248 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
249 if (o == NULL)
250 return false;
251 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
252 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
253 }
254 return true;
255 }
256
257
258 bool
259 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
260 {
261 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
262 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
263 bed->target_id);
264 }
265
266 bool
267 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
268 {
269 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
270 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
271 return false;
272 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
273 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
274 }
275
276 char *
277 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
278 {
279 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
280 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
281 file_ptr offset;
282 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
283
284 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
285 if (i_shdrp == 0
286 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
287 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
288 return NULL;
289
290 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
291 if (shstrtab == NULL)
292 {
293 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
294 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
295 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
296
297 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
298 in case the string table is not terminated. */
299 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
300 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
301 || (shstrtab = _bfd_alloc_and_read (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1,
302 shstrtabsize)) == NULL)
303 {
304 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
305 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
306 the string table over and over. */
307 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
308 }
309 else
310 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
311 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
312 }
313 return (char *) shstrtab;
314 }
315
316 char *
317 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
318 unsigned int shindex,
319 unsigned int strindex)
320 {
321 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
322
323 if (strindex == 0)
324 return "";
325
326 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
327 return NULL;
328
329 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
330
331 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
332 {
333 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
334 {
335 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
336 /* xgettext:c-format */
337 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: attempt to load strings from"
338 " a non-string section (number %d)"),
339 abfd, shindex);
340 return NULL;
341 }
342
343 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
344 return NULL;
345 }
346 else
347 {
348 /* PR 24273: The string section's contents may have already
349 been loaded elsewhere, eg because a corrupt file has the
350 string section index in the ELF header pointing at a group
351 section. So be paranoid, and test that the last byte of
352 the section is zero. */
353 if (hdr->sh_size == 0 || hdr->contents[hdr->sh_size - 1] != 0)
354 return NULL;
355 }
356
357 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
358 {
359 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
360 _bfd_error_handler
361 /* xgettext:c-format */
362 (_("%pB: invalid string offset %u >= %" PRIu64 " for section `%s'"),
363 abfd, strindex, (uint64_t) hdr->sh_size,
364 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
365 ? ".shstrtab"
366 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
367 return NULL;
368 }
369
370 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
371 }
372
373 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
374 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
375 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
376 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
377 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
378 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
379 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
380
381 Elf_Internal_Sym *
382 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
383 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
384 size_t symcount,
385 size_t symoffset,
386 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
387 void *extsym_buf,
388 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
389 {
390 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
391 void *alloc_ext;
392 const bfd_byte *esym;
393 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
394 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
395 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
396 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
397 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
398 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
399 size_t extsym_size;
400 size_t amt;
401 file_ptr pos;
402
403 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
404 abort ();
405
406 if (symcount == 0)
407 return intsym_buf;
408
409 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
410 shndx_hdr = NULL;
411 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
412 {
413 elf_section_list * entry;
414 Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
415
416 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
417 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
418 {
419 /* PR 20063. */
420 if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
421 continue;
422
423 if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
424 {
425 shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
426 break;
427 };
428 }
429
430 if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
431 {
432 if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
433 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
434 shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
435 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
436 the index table will not be needed. */
437 }
438 }
439
440 /* Read the symbols. */
441 alloc_ext = NULL;
442 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
443 alloc_intsym = NULL;
444 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
445 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
446 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount, extsym_size, &amt))
447 {
448 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
449 intsym_buf = NULL;
450 goto out;
451 }
452 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
453 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
454 {
455 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc (amt);
456 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
457 }
458 if (extsym_buf == NULL
459 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
460 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
461 {
462 intsym_buf = NULL;
463 goto out;
464 }
465
466 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
467 extshndx_buf = NULL;
468 else
469 {
470 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx), &amt))
471 {
472 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
473 intsym_buf = NULL;
474 goto out;
475 }
476 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
477 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
478 {
479 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *) bfd_malloc (amt);
480 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
481 }
482 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
483 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
484 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
485 {
486 intsym_buf = NULL;
487 goto out;
488 }
489 }
490
491 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
492 {
493 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym), &amt))
494 {
495 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
496 goto out;
497 }
498 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) bfd_malloc (amt);
499 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
500 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
501 goto out;
502 }
503
504 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
505 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
506 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
507 shndx = extshndx_buf;
508 isym < isymend;
509 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
510 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
511 {
512 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
513 /* xgettext:c-format */
514 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB symbol number %lu references"
515 " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
516 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
517 free (alloc_intsym);
518 intsym_buf = NULL;
519 goto out;
520 }
521
522 out:
523 free (alloc_ext);
524 free (alloc_extshndx);
525
526 return intsym_buf;
527 }
528
529 /* Look up a symbol name. */
530 const char *
531 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
532 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
533 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
534 asection *sym_sec)
535 {
536 const char *name;
537 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
538 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
539
540 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
541 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
542 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
543 {
544 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
545 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
546 }
547
548 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
549 if (name == NULL)
550 name = "(null)";
551 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
552 name = bfd_section_name (sym_sec);
553
554 return name;
555 }
556
557 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
558 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
559 pointers. */
560
561 typedef union elf_internal_group {
562 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
563 unsigned int flags;
564 } Elf_Internal_Group;
565
566 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
567 signature just a string? */
568
569 static const char *
570 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
571 {
572 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
573 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
574 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
575 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
576
577 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
578 that it is a symbol table section. */
579 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
580 return NULL;
581 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
582 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
583 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
584 return NULL;
585
586 /* Go read the symbol. */
587 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
588 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
589 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
590 return NULL;
591
592 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
593 }
594
595 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
596
597 static bool
598 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
599 {
600 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
601
602 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
603 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
604 if (num_group == 0)
605 {
606 unsigned int i, shnum;
607
608 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
609 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
610 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
611 num_group = 0;
612
613 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
614 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
615 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
616 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
617 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
618
619 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
620 {
621 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
622
623 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
624 num_group += 1;
625 }
626
627 if (num_group == 0)
628 {
629 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
630 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
631 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
632 }
633 else
634 {
635 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
636 so we can find them quickly. */
637 size_t amt;
638
639 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
640 amt = num_group * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *);
641 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr
642 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
643 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
644 return false;
645 num_group = 0;
646
647 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
648 {
649 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
650
651 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
652 {
653 unsigned char *src;
654 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
655
656 /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
657 attached to it. */
658 if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
659 return false;
660
661 /* Add to list of sections. */
662 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
663 num_group += 1;
664
665 /* Read the raw contents. */
666 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4 && sizeof (*dest) % 4 == 0);
667 shdr->contents = NULL;
668 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (shdr->sh_size,
669 sizeof (*dest) / 4, &amt)
670 || bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
671 || !(shdr->contents
672 = _bfd_alloc_and_read (abfd, amt, shdr->sh_size)))
673 {
674 _bfd_error_handler
675 /* xgettext:c-format */
676 (_("%pB: invalid size field in group section"
677 " header: %#" PRIx64 ""),
678 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
679 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
680 -- num_group;
681 continue;
682 }
683
684 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
685 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
686 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
687 pointers. */
688 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
689 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
690
691 while (1)
692 {
693 unsigned int idx;
694
695 src -= 4;
696 --dest;
697 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
698 if (src == shdr->contents)
699 {
700 dest->shdr = NULL;
701 dest->flags = idx;
702 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
703 shdr->bfd_section->flags
704 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
705 break;
706 }
707 if (idx < shnum)
708 {
709 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
710 /* PR binutils/23199: All sections in a
711 section group should be marked with
712 SHF_GROUP. But some tools generate
713 broken objects without SHF_GROUP. Fix
714 them up here. */
715 dest->shdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
716 }
717 if (idx >= shnum
718 || dest->shdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
719 {
720 _bfd_error_handler
721 (_("%pB: invalid entry in SHT_GROUP section [%u]"),
722 abfd, i);
723 dest->shdr = NULL;
724 }
725 }
726 }
727 }
728
729 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
730 if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
731 {
732 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
733
734 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
735 if (num_group == 0)
736 {
737 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
738 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
739 _bfd_error_handler
740 (_("%pB: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
741 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
742 }
743 }
744 }
745 }
746
747 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
748 {
749 unsigned int search_offset = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset;
750 unsigned int j;
751
752 for (j = 0; j < num_group; j++)
753 {
754 /* Begin search from previous found group. */
755 unsigned i = (j + search_offset) % num_group;
756
757 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
758 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
759 bfd_size_type n_elt;
760
761 if (shdr == NULL)
762 continue;
763
764 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
765 if (idx == NULL || shdr->sh_size < 4)
766 {
767 /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
768 /* xgettext:c-format */
769 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: group section '%pA' has no contents"),
770 abfd, shdr->bfd_section);
771 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i] = NULL;
772 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
773 return false;
774 }
775 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
776
777 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
778 section is a member. */
779 while (--n_elt != 0)
780 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
781 {
782 asection *s = NULL;
783
784 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
785 other members to see if any others are linked via
786 next_in_group. */
787 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
788 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
789 while (--n_elt != 0)
790 if ((++idx)->shdr != NULL
791 && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
792 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
793 break;
794 if (n_elt != 0)
795 {
796 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
797 insert current section in circular list. */
798 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
799 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
800 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
801 }
802 else
803 {
804 const char *gname;
805
806 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
807 if (gname == NULL)
808 return false;
809 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
810
811 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
812 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
813 }
814
815 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
816 new member. */
817 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
818 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
819
820 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset = i;
821 j = num_group - 1;
822 break;
823 }
824 }
825 }
826
827 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
828 {
829 /* xgettext:c-format */
830 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: no group info for section '%pA'"),
831 abfd, newsect);
832 return false;
833 }
834 return true;
835 }
836
837 bool
838 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
839 {
840 unsigned int i;
841 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
842 bool result = true;
843 asection *s;
844
845 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
846 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
847 {
848 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
849 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
850 {
851 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
852 /* An sh_link value of 0 is now allowed. It indicates that linked
853 to section has already been discarded, but that the current
854 section has been retained for some other reason. This linking
855 section is still a candidate for later garbage collection
856 however. */
857 if (elfsec == 0)
858 {
859 elf_linked_to_section (s) = NULL;
860 }
861 else
862 {
863 asection *linksec = NULL;
864
865 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
866 {
867 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
868 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
869 }
870
871 /* PR 1991, 2008:
872 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
873 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
874 if (linksec == NULL)
875 {
876 _bfd_error_handler
877 /* xgettext:c-format */
878 (_("%pB: sh_link [%d] in section `%pA' is incorrect"),
879 s->owner, elfsec, s);
880 result = false;
881 }
882
883 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
884 }
885 }
886 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
887 && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
888 {
889 _bfd_error_handler
890 /* xgettext:c-format */
891 (_("%pB: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
892 abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
893 result = false;
894 }
895 }
896
897 /* Process section groups. */
898 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
899 return result;
900
901 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
902 {
903 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
904 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
905 unsigned int n_elt;
906
907 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
908 if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
909 {
910 _bfd_error_handler
911 /* xgettext:c-format */
912 (_("%pB: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
913 abfd, i);
914 result = false;
915 continue;
916 }
917
918 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
919 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
920
921 while (--n_elt != 0)
922 {
923 ++ idx;
924
925 if (idx->shdr == NULL)
926 continue;
927 else if (idx->shdr->bfd_section)
928 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
929 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA
930 && idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
931 {
932 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
933 _bfd_error_handler
934 /* xgettext:c-format */
935 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%pA]"),
936 abfd,
937 idx->shdr->sh_type,
938 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
939 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
940 ->e_shstrndx),
941 idx->shdr->sh_name),
942 shdr->bfd_section);
943 result = false;
944 }
945 }
946 }
947
948 return result;
949 }
950
951 bool
952 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
953 {
954 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
955 }
956
957 const char *
958 bfd_elf_group_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
959 {
960 if (elf_sec_group (sec) != NULL)
961 return elf_group_name (sec);
962 return NULL;
963 }
964
965 static char *
966 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
967 {
968 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
969 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
970 if (new_name == NULL)
971 return NULL;
972 new_name[0] = '.';
973 new_name[1] = 'z';
974 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
975 return new_name;
976 }
977
978 static char *
979 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
980 {
981 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
982 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
983 if (new_name == NULL)
984 return NULL;
985 new_name[0] = '.';
986 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
987 return new_name;
988 }
989
990 /* This a copy of lto_section defined in GCC (lto-streamer.h). */
991
992 struct lto_section
993 {
994 int16_t major_version;
995 int16_t minor_version;
996 unsigned char slim_object;
997
998 /* Flags is a private field that is not defined publicly. */
999 uint16_t flags;
1000 };
1001
1002 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
1003 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
1004
1005 bool
1006 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1007 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1008 const char *name,
1009 int shindex)
1010 {
1011 asection *newsect;
1012 flagword flags;
1013 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1014 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
1015
1016 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1017 return true;
1018
1019 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
1020 if (newsect == NULL)
1021 return false;
1022
1023 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
1024 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
1025 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
1026
1027 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
1028 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
1029 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
1030
1031 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1032
1033 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
1034 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1035 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
1036 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
1037 flags |= SEC_GROUP;
1038 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1039 {
1040 flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
1041 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1042 flags |= SEC_LOAD;
1043 }
1044 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
1045 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
1046 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
1047 flags |= SEC_CODE;
1048 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1049 flags |= SEC_DATA;
1050 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
1051 {
1052 flags |= SEC_MERGE;
1053 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
1054 }
1055 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
1056 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
1057 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
1058 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
1059 return false;
1060 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
1061 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
1062 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
1063 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1064
1065 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI])
1066 {
1067 /* FIXME: We should not recognize SHF_GNU_MBIND for ELFOSABI_NONE,
1068 but binutils as of 2019-07-23 did not set the EI_OSABI header
1069 byte. */
1070 case ELFOSABI_GNU:
1071 case ELFOSABI_FREEBSD:
1072 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GNU_RETAIN) != 0)
1073 elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi |= elf_gnu_osabi_retain;
1074 /* Fall through */
1075 case ELFOSABI_NONE:
1076 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
1077 elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi |= elf_gnu_osabi_mbind;
1078 break;
1079 }
1080
1081 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1082 {
1083 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1084 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1085 if (name [0] == '.')
1086 {
1087 if (startswith (name, ".debug")
1088 || startswith (name, ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_")
1089 || startswith (name, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.")
1090 || startswith (name, ".zdebug"))
1091 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING | SEC_ELF_OCTETS;
1092 else if (startswith (name, GNU_BUILD_ATTRS_SECTION_NAME)
1093 || startswith (name, ".note.gnu"))
1094 {
1095 flags |= SEC_ELF_OCTETS;
1096 opb = 1;
1097 }
1098 else if (startswith (name, ".line")
1099 || startswith (name, ".stab")
1100 || strcmp (name, ".gdb_index") == 0)
1101 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1102 }
1103 }
1104
1105 if (!bfd_set_section_vma (newsect, hdr->sh_addr / opb)
1106 || !bfd_set_section_size (newsect, hdr->sh_size)
1107 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (newsect, bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
1108 return false;
1109
1110 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1111 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1112 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1113 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1114 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1115 all but one of the sections. */
1116 if (startswith (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1117 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1118 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1119
1120 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, flags))
1121 return false;
1122
1123 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1124 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1125 if (!bed->elf_backend_section_flags (hdr))
1126 return false;
1127
1128 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1129 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1130 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1131 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1132 {
1133 bfd_byte *contents;
1134
1135 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1136 return false;
1137
1138 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size,
1139 hdr->sh_offset, hdr->sh_addralign);
1140 free (contents);
1141 }
1142
1143 if ((newsect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1144 {
1145 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1146 unsigned int i, nload;
1147
1148 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1149 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1150 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1151 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1152 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1153 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1154 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1155 break;
1156 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1157 ++nload;
1158 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1159 return true;
1160
1161 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1162 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1163 {
1164 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1165 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1166 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1167 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1168 {
1169 if ((newsect->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1170 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1171 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr) / opb;
1172 else
1173 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1174 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1175 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1176 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1177 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1178 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1179 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1180 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1181 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset) / opb;
1182
1183 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1184 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1185 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1186 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1187 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1188 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1189 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1190 break;
1191 }
1192 }
1193 }
1194
1195 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1196 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1197 if ((newsect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1198 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1199 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1200 {
1201 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1202 int compression_header_size;
1203 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1204 unsigned int uncompressed_align_power;
1205 bool compressed
1206 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1207 &compression_header_size,
1208 &uncompressed_size,
1209 &uncompressed_align_power);
1210 if (compressed)
1211 {
1212 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1213 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1214 action = decompress;
1215 }
1216
1217 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1218 section. Check if we should compress. */
1219 if (action == nothing)
1220 {
1221 if (newsect->size != 0
1222 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1223 && compression_header_size >= 0
1224 && uncompressed_size > 0
1225 && (!compressed
1226 || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1227 != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1228 action = compress;
1229 else
1230 return true;
1231 }
1232
1233 if (action == compress)
1234 {
1235 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1236 {
1237 _bfd_error_handler
1238 /* xgettext:c-format */
1239 (_("%pB: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1240 abfd, name);
1241 return false;
1242 }
1243 }
1244 else
1245 {
1246 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1247 {
1248 _bfd_error_handler
1249 /* xgettext:c-format */
1250 (_("%pB: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1251 abfd, name);
1252 return false;
1253 }
1254 }
1255
1256 if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1257 {
1258 if (name[1] == 'z'
1259 && (action == decompress
1260 || (action == compress
1261 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1262 {
1263 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1264 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1265 section. */
1266 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1267 if (new_name == NULL)
1268 return false;
1269 bfd_rename_section (newsect, new_name);
1270 }
1271 }
1272 else
1273 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1274 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1275 newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1276 }
1277
1278 /* GCC uses .gnu.lto_.lto.<some_hash> as a LTO bytecode information
1279 section. */
1280 if (startswith (name, ".gnu.lto_.lto."))
1281 {
1282 struct lto_section lsection;
1283 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, newsect, &lsection, 0,
1284 sizeof (struct lto_section)))
1285 abfd->lto_slim_object = lsection.slim_object;
1286 }
1287
1288 return true;
1289 }
1290
1291 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
1292 {
1293 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1294 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1295 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1296 };
1297
1298 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1299 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1300 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1301 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1302 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1303 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1304 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1305 function, or should call this function for relocatable output. */
1306
1307 bfd_reloc_status_type
1308 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1309 arelent *reloc_entry,
1310 asymbol *symbol,
1311 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1312 asection *input_section,
1313 bfd *output_bfd,
1314 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1315 {
1316 if (output_bfd != NULL
1317 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1318 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1319 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1320 {
1321 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1322 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1323 }
1324
1325 /* In some cases the relocation should be treated as output section
1326 relative, as when linking ELF DWARF into PE COFF. Many ELF
1327 targets lack section relative relocations and instead use
1328 ordinary absolute relocations for references between DWARF
1329 sections. That is arguably a bug in those targets but it happens
1330 to work for the usual case of linking to non-loaded ELF debug
1331 sections with VMAs forced to zero. PE COFF on the other hand
1332 doesn't allow a section VMA of zero. */
1333 if (output_bfd == NULL
1334 && !reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative
1335 && (symbol->section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
1336 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
1337 reloc_entry->addend -= symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1338
1339 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1340 }
1341 \f
1342 /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1343 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1344 should be the same. */
1345
1346 static bool
1347 section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
1348 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
1349 {
1350 if (a->sh_type != b->sh_type
1351 || ((a->sh_flags ^ b->sh_flags) & ~SHF_INFO_LINK) != 0
1352 || a->sh_addralign != b->sh_addralign
1353 || a->sh_entsize != b->sh_entsize)
1354 return false;
1355 if (a->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
1356 || a->sh_type == SHT_STRTAB)
1357 return true;
1358 return a->sh_size == b->sh_size;
1359 }
1360
1361 /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1362 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1363 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1364 to be the correct section. */
1365
1366 static unsigned int
1367 find_link (const bfd *obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1368 const unsigned int hint)
1369 {
1370 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1371 unsigned int i;
1372
1373 BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
1374
1375 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1376 if (hint < elf_numsections (obfd)
1377 && oheaders[hint] != NULL
1378 && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
1379 return hint;
1380
1381 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1382 {
1383 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1384
1385 if (oheader == NULL)
1386 continue;
1387 if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
1388 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1389 multiple matches ? */
1390 return i;
1391 }
1392
1393 return SHN_UNDEF;
1394 }
1395
1396 /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1397 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1398 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1399
1400 static bool
1401 copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
1402 bfd *obfd,
1403 const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1404 Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
1405 const unsigned int secnum)
1406 {
1407 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1408 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1409 bool changed = false;
1410 unsigned int sh_link;
1411
1412 if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
1413 {
1414 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1415 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1416 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1417 matched up with the original.
1418
1419 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1420 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1421 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1422 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1423 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1424 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1425 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1426 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1427 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1428 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1429 without any contents. */
1430 if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1431 oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1432 if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1433 oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1434 return true;
1435 }
1436
1437 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1438 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd,
1439 iheader, oheader))
1440 return true;
1441
1442 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1443 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1444 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1445 in the input bfd. */
1446 if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1447 {
1448 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1449 if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
1450 {
1451 _bfd_error_handler
1452 /* xgettext:c-format */
1453 (_("%pB: invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1454 ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
1455 return false;
1456 }
1457
1458 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
1459 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1460 {
1461 oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
1462 changed = true;
1463 }
1464 else
1465 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1466 if we could not find a match ? */
1467 _bfd_error_handler
1468 /* xgettext:c-format */
1469 (_("%pB: failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1470 }
1471
1472 if (iheader->sh_info)
1473 {
1474 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1475 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1476 section index. */
1477 if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
1478 {
1479 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
1480 iheader->sh_info);
1481 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1482 oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
1483 }
1484 else
1485 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1486 sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
1487
1488 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1489 {
1490 oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
1491 changed = true;
1492 }
1493 else
1494 _bfd_error_handler
1495 /* xgettext:c-format */
1496 (_("%pB: failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1497 }
1498
1499 return changed;
1500 }
1501
1502 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1503 another. */
1504
1505 bool
1506 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1507 {
1508 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1509 Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1510 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1511 unsigned int i;
1512
1513 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1514 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1515 return true;
1516
1517 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1518 {
1519 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1520 elf_flags_init (obfd) = true;
1521 }
1522
1523 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1524
1525 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1526 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1527 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1528
1529 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1530 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
1531 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
1532 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
1533
1534 /* Copy object attributes. */
1535 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1536
1537 if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
1538 return true;
1539
1540 bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1541
1542 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1543 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1544 {
1545 unsigned int j;
1546 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1547
1548 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1549 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1550 files. See below for more details. */
1551 if (oheader == NULL
1552 || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1553 && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
1554 continue;
1555
1556 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1557 fields have already been initialised. */
1558 if (oheader->sh_size == 0
1559 || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1560 continue;
1561
1562 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1563 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1564 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1565 {
1566 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1567
1568 if (iheader == NULL)
1569 continue;
1570
1571 if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
1572 && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
1573 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
1574 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
1575 {
1576 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1577 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1578 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1579 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1580 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1581 j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
1582 break;
1583 }
1584 }
1585
1586 if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
1587 continue;
1588
1589 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1590 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1591 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1592 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1593 {
1594 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1595
1596 if (iheader == NULL)
1597 continue;
1598
1599 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1600 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1601 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1602 input type. */
1603 if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1604 || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1605 && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1606 == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1607 && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1608 && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1609 && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1610 && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1611 && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1612 || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1613 {
1614 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1615 break;
1616 }
1617 }
1618
1619 if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
1620 {
1621 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1622 with a NULL input section. */
1623 (void) bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd,
1624 NULL, oheader);
1625 }
1626 }
1627
1628 return true;
1629 }
1630
1631 static const char *
1632 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1633 {
1634 const char *pt;
1635 switch (p_type)
1636 {
1637 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1638 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1639 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1640 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1641 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1642 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1643 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1644 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1645 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1646 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1647 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1648 default: pt = NULL; break;
1649 }
1650 return pt;
1651 }
1652
1653 /* Print out the program headers. */
1654
1655 bool
1656 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1657 {
1658 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1659 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1660 asection *s;
1661 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1662
1663 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1664 if (p != NULL)
1665 {
1666 unsigned int i, c;
1667
1668 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1669 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1670 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1671 {
1672 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1673 char buf[20];
1674
1675 if (pt == NULL)
1676 {
1677 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1678 pt = buf;
1679 }
1680 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1681 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1682 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1683 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1684 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1685 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1686 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1687 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1688 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1689 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1690 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1691 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1692 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1693 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1694 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1695 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1696 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1697 fprintf (f, "\n");
1698 }
1699 }
1700
1701 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1702 if (s != NULL)
1703 {
1704 unsigned int elfsec;
1705 unsigned long shlink;
1706 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1707 size_t extdynsize;
1708 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1709
1710 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1711
1712 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1713 goto error_return;
1714
1715 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1716 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1717 goto error_return;
1718 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1719
1720 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1721 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1722
1723 extdyn = dynbuf;
1724 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1725 if (s->size < extdynsize)
1726 goto error_return;
1727 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1728 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1729 Fix range check. */
1730 for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1731 {
1732 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1733 const char *name = "";
1734 char ab[20];
1735 bool stringp;
1736 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1737
1738 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1739
1740 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1741 break;
1742
1743 stringp = false;
1744 switch (dyn.d_tag)
1745 {
1746 default:
1747 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1748 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1749
1750 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1751 {
1752 sprintf (ab, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT "x", dyn.d_tag);
1753 name = ab;
1754 }
1755 break;
1756
1757 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = true; break;
1758 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1759 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1760 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1761 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1762 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1763 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1764 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1765 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1766 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1767 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1768 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1769 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1770 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = true; break;
1771 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = true; break;
1772 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1773 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1774 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1775 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1776 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1777 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1778 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1779 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1780 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1781 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1782 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1783 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1784 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1785 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = true; break;
1786 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1787 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1788 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1789 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1790 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1791 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1792 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1793 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1794 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1795 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1796 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1797 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = true; break;
1798 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = true; break;
1799 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = true; break;
1800 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1801 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1802 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1803 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1804 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1805 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1806 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1807 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1808 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1809 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1810 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1811 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = true; break;
1812 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1813 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = true; break;
1814 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1815 }
1816
1817 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1818 if (! stringp)
1819 {
1820 fprintf (f, "0x");
1821 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1822 }
1823 else
1824 {
1825 const char *string;
1826 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1827
1828 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1829 if (string == NULL)
1830 goto error_return;
1831 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1832 }
1833 fprintf (f, "\n");
1834 }
1835
1836 free (dynbuf);
1837 dynbuf = NULL;
1838 }
1839
1840 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1841 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1842 {
1843 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, false))
1844 return false;
1845 }
1846
1847 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1848 {
1849 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1850
1851 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1852 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1853 {
1854 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1855 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1856 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1857 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1858 {
1859 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1860
1861 fprintf (f, "\t");
1862 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1863 a != NULL;
1864 a = a->vda_nextptr)
1865 fprintf (f, "%s ",
1866 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1867 fprintf (f, "\n");
1868 }
1869 }
1870 }
1871
1872 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1873 {
1874 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1875
1876 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1877 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1878 {
1879 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1880
1881 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1882 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1883 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1884 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1885 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1886 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1887 }
1888 }
1889
1890 return true;
1891
1892 error_return:
1893 free (dynbuf);
1894 return false;
1895 }
1896
1897 /* Get version name. If BASE_P is TRUE, return "Base" for VER_FLG_BASE
1898 and return symbol version for symbol version itself. */
1899
1900 const char *
1901 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1902 bool base_p,
1903 bool *hidden)
1904 {
1905 const char *version_string = NULL;
1906 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1907 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1908 {
1909 unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1910
1911 *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1912 vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1913
1914 if (vernum == 0)
1915 version_string = "";
1916 else if (vernum == 1
1917 && (vernum > elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs
1918 || (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[0].vd_flags
1919 == VER_FLG_BASE)))
1920 version_string = base_p ? "Base" : "";
1921 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1922 {
1923 const char *nodename
1924 = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1925 version_string = "";
1926 if (base_p
1927 || nodename == NULL
1928 || symbol->name == NULL
1929 || strcmp (symbol->name, nodename) != 0)
1930 version_string = nodename;
1931 }
1932 else
1933 {
1934 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1935
1936 version_string = _("<corrupt>");
1937 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1938 t != NULL;
1939 t = t->vn_nextref)
1940 {
1941 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1942
1943 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1944 {
1945 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1946 {
1947 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1948 break;
1949 }
1950 }
1951 }
1952 }
1953 }
1954 return version_string;
1955 }
1956
1957 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1958
1959 void
1960 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1961 void *filep,
1962 asymbol *symbol,
1963 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1964 {
1965 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1966 switch (how)
1967 {
1968 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1969 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1970 break;
1971 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1972 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1973 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1974 fprintf (file, " %x", symbol->flags);
1975 break;
1976 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1977 {
1978 const char *section_name;
1979 const char *name = NULL;
1980 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1981 unsigned char st_other;
1982 bfd_vma val;
1983 const char *version_string;
1984 bool hidden;
1985
1986 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1987
1988 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1989 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1990 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1991
1992 if (name == NULL)
1993 {
1994 name = symbol->name;
1995 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1996 }
1997
1998 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1999 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
2000 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
2001 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
2002 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
2003 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
2004 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
2005 else
2006 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
2007 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
2008
2009 /* If we have version information, print it. */
2010 version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
2011 symbol,
2012 true,
2013 &hidden);
2014 if (version_string)
2015 {
2016 if (!hidden)
2017 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
2018 else
2019 {
2020 int i;
2021
2022 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
2023 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
2024 putc (' ', file);
2025 }
2026 }
2027
2028 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
2029 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
2030
2031 switch (st_other)
2032 {
2033 case 0: break;
2034 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
2035 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
2036 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
2037 default:
2038 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
2039 everything hex. */
2040 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
2041 }
2042
2043 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
2044 }
2045 break;
2046 }
2047 }
2048 \f
2049 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
2050
2051 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
2052
2053 bool
2054 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
2055 {
2056 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
2057 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
2058 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2059 const char *name;
2060 bool ret = true;
2061
2062 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2063 return false;
2064
2065 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a loop of sections via
2066 sh_link or sh_info. Detect this here, by refusing to load a
2067 section that we are already in the process of loading. */
2068 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->being_created[shindex])
2069 {
2070 _bfd_error_handler
2071 (_("%pB: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
2072 return false;
2073 }
2074 elf_tdata (abfd)->being_created[shindex] = true;
2075
2076 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
2077 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
2078 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
2079 hdr->sh_name);
2080 if (name == NULL)
2081 goto fail;
2082
2083 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2084 switch (hdr->sh_type)
2085 {
2086 case SHT_NULL:
2087 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2088 goto success;
2089
2090 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
2091 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
2092 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
2093 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
2094 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
2095 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
2096 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
2097 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2098 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2099 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2100 goto success;
2101
2102 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2103 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2104 goto fail;
2105
2106 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
2107 {
2108 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2109 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2110 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
2111 {
2112 case bfd_arch_i386:
2113 case bfd_arch_sparc:
2114 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2115 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2116 break;
2117 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2118 default:
2119 goto fail;
2120 }
2121 }
2122 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
2123 goto fail;
2124 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
2125 {
2126 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
2127
2128 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2129 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2130 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2131 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2132 {
2133 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
2134 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2135 }
2136 else
2137 {
2138 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2139
2140 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2141 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2142 {
2143 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2144 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2145 {
2146 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2147 break;
2148 }
2149 }
2150 }
2151 }
2152 goto success;
2153
2154 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
2155 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2156 goto success;
2157
2158 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2159 goto fail;
2160
2161 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2162 {
2163 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2164 goto fail;
2165 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2166 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2167 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2168 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2169 goto success;
2170 }
2171
2172 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2173 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2174 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
2175 {
2176 _bfd_error_handler
2177 /* xgettext:c-format */
2178 (_("%pB: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2179 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2180 abfd, shindex);
2181 goto success;
2182 }
2183 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2184 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
2185 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2186 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2187
2188 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2189 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2190 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2191 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2192 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2193 linker. */
2194 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
2195 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
2196 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2197 shindex))
2198 goto fail;
2199
2200 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2201 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2202 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2203 {
2204 elf_section_list * entry;
2205 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2206
2207 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2208 if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
2209 goto success;
2210
2211 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2212 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2213 {
2214 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2215
2216 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2217 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2218 break;
2219 }
2220
2221 if (i == num_sec)
2222 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
2223 {
2224 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2225
2226 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2227 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2228 break;
2229 }
2230
2231 if (i != shindex)
2232 ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
2233 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2234 goto success;
2235 }
2236
2237 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2238 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2239 goto success;
2240
2241 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2242 goto fail;
2243
2244 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2245 {
2246 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2247 goto fail;
2248
2249 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2250 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2251 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2252 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2253 goto success;
2254 }
2255
2256 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2257 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2258 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2259 {
2260 _bfd_error_handler
2261 /* xgettext:c-format */
2262 (_("%pB: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2263 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2264 abfd, shindex);
2265 goto success;
2266 }
2267 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2268 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
2269 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
2270 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2271
2272 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2273 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2274 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2275 goto success;
2276
2277 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2278 {
2279 elf_section_list * entry;
2280
2281 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2282 if (entry->ndx == shindex)
2283 goto success;
2284
2285 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
2286 if (entry == NULL)
2287 goto fail;
2288 entry->ndx = shindex;
2289 entry->hdr = * hdr;
2290 entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
2291 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
2292 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
2293 goto success;
2294 }
2295
2296 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
2297 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
2298 goto success;
2299
2300 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
2301 {
2302 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2303 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
2304 goto success;
2305 }
2306
2307 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2308 {
2309 symtab_strtab:
2310 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
2311 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
2312 goto success;
2313 }
2314
2315 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2316 {
2317 dynsymtab_strtab:
2318 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2319 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2320 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2321 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2322 can handle it. */
2323 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2324 shindex);
2325 goto success;
2326 }
2327
2328 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2329 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2330 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2331 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2332 {
2333 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2334
2335 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2336 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2337 {
2338 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2339 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2340 {
2341 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2342 if (i == shindex)
2343 goto fail;
2344 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2345 goto fail;
2346 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2347 goto symtab_strtab;
2348 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2349 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2350 }
2351 }
2352 }
2353 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2354 goto success;
2355
2356 case SHT_REL:
2357 case SHT_RELA:
2358 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2359 {
2360 asection *target_sect;
2361 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2362 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2363 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2364
2365 if (hdr->sh_entsize
2366 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2367 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2368 goto fail;
2369
2370 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2371 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2372 {
2373 _bfd_error_handler
2374 /* xgettext:c-format */
2375 (_("%pB: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2376 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
2377 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2378 shindex);
2379 goto success;
2380 }
2381
2382 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2383 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2384 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2385 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2386 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2387 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2388 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2389
2390 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2391 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2392 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2393 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2394 {
2395 unsigned int scan;
2396 int found;
2397
2398 found = 0;
2399 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2400 {
2401 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2402 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2403 {
2404 if (found != 0)
2405 {
2406 found = 0;
2407 break;
2408 }
2409 found = scan;
2410 }
2411 }
2412 if (found != 0)
2413 hdr->sh_link = found;
2414 }
2415
2416 /* Get the symbol table. */
2417 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2418 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2419 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2420 goto fail;
2421
2422 /* If this is an alloc section in an executable or shared
2423 library, or the reloc section does not use the main symbol
2424 table we don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't
2425 adequately represent such a section, so at least for now,
2426 we don't try. We just present it as a normal section. We
2427 also can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the
2428 null section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or
2429 its sh_link points to the null section. */
2430 if (((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) != 0
2431 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2432 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2433 || hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2434 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2435 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2436 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2437 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2438 {
2439 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2440 shindex);
2441 goto success;
2442 }
2443
2444 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2445 goto fail;
2446
2447 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2448 if (target_sect == NULL)
2449 goto fail;
2450
2451 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2452 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2453 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2454 else
2455 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2456
2457 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7.
2458 Also see PR 24456, for a file which deliberately has two reloc
2459 sections. */
2460 if (*p_hdr != NULL)
2461 {
2462 if (!bed->init_secondary_reloc_section (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2463 {
2464 _bfd_error_handler
2465 /* xgettext:c-format */
2466 (_("%pB: warning: secondary relocation section '%s' "
2467 "for section %pA found - ignoring"),
2468 abfd, name, target_sect);
2469 }
2470 goto success;
2471 }
2472
2473 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
2474 if (hdr2 == NULL)
2475 goto fail;
2476 *hdr2 = *hdr;
2477 *p_hdr = hdr2;
2478 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2479 target_sect->reloc_count += (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr)
2480 * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
2481 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2482 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2483 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2484 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2485 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2486 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2487 {
2488 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2489 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2490 }
2491 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2492 goto success;
2493 }
2494
2495 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2496 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2497 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2498 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2499 goto success;
2500
2501 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2502 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2503 goto fail;
2504
2505 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2506 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2507 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2508 goto success;
2509
2510 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2511 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2512 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2513 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2514 goto success;
2515
2516 case SHT_SHLIB:
2517 goto success;
2518
2519 case SHT_GROUP:
2520 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2521 goto fail;
2522
2523 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2524 goto fail;
2525
2526 goto success;
2527
2528 default:
2529 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2530 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2531 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2532 {
2533 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2534 goto fail;
2535 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2536 goto success;
2537 }
2538
2539 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2540 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2541 goto success;
2542
2543 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2544 {
2545 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2546 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2547 for applications? */
2548 _bfd_error_handler
2549 /* xgettext:c-format */
2550 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2551 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2552 else
2553 {
2554 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2555 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2556 shindex);
2557 goto success;
2558 }
2559 }
2560 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2561 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2562 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2563 _bfd_error_handler
2564 /* xgettext:c-format */
2565 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2566 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2567 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2568 {
2569 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2570 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2571 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2572 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2573 be rejected with an error message. */
2574 _bfd_error_handler
2575 /* xgettext:c-format */
2576 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2577 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2578 else
2579 {
2580 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2581 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2582 goto success;
2583 }
2584 }
2585 else
2586 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2587 _bfd_error_handler
2588 /* xgettext:c-format */
2589 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2590 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2591
2592 goto fail;
2593 }
2594
2595 fail:
2596 ret = false;
2597 success:
2598 elf_tdata (abfd)->being_created[shindex] = false;
2599 return ret;
2600 }
2601
2602 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2603
2604 Elf_Internal_Sym *
2605 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2606 bfd *abfd,
2607 unsigned long r_symndx)
2608 {
2609 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2610
2611 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2612 {
2613 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2614 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2615 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2616
2617 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2618 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2619 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2620 return NULL;
2621
2622 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2623 {
2624 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2625 cache->abfd = abfd;
2626 }
2627 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2628 }
2629
2630 return &cache->sym[ent];
2631 }
2632
2633 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2634 section. */
2635
2636 asection *
2637 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2638 {
2639 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2640 return NULL;
2641 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2642 }
2643
2644 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2645 {
2646 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2647 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2648 };
2649
2650 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2651 {
2652 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2653 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ctf"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2654 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2655 };
2656
2657 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2658 {
2659 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2660 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2661 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2662 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2663 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2664 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2665 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2666 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2667 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2668 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2669 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2670 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2671 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2672 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2673 };
2674
2675 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2676 {
2677 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2678 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2679 { NULL, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2680 };
2681
2682 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2683 {
2684 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2685 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.n"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2686 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.p"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2687 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2688 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2689 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2690 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2691 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2692 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2693 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2694 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2695 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2696 };
2697
2698 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2699 {
2700 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2701 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2702 };
2703
2704 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2705 {
2706 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2707 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2708 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2709 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2710 };
2711
2712 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2713 {
2714 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2715 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2716 };
2717
2718 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2719 {
2720 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".noinit"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2721 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2722 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2723 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2724 };
2725
2726 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2727 {
2728 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".persistent"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2729 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2730 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2731 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2732 };
2733
2734 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2735 {
2736 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2737 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2738 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2739 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2740 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2741 };
2742
2743 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2744 {
2745 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2746 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2747 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2748 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2749 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2750 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2751 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2752 };
2753
2754 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2755 {
2756 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2757 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2758 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2759 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2760 };
2761
2762 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2763 {
2764 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2765 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2766 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2767 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2768 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2769 };
2770
2771 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2772 {
2773 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2774 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2775 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2776 NULL, /* 'e' */
2777 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2778 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2779 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2780 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2781 NULL, /* 'j' */
2782 NULL, /* 'k' */
2783 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2784 NULL, /* 'm' */
2785 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2786 NULL, /* 'o' */
2787 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2788 NULL, /* 'q' */
2789 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2790 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2791 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2792 NULL, /* 'u' */
2793 NULL, /* 'v' */
2794 NULL, /* 'w' */
2795 NULL, /* 'x' */
2796 NULL, /* 'y' */
2797 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2798 };
2799
2800 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2801 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2802 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2803 unsigned int rela)
2804 {
2805 int i;
2806 int len;
2807
2808 len = strlen (name);
2809
2810 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2811 {
2812 int suffix_len;
2813 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2814
2815 if (len < prefix_len)
2816 continue;
2817 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2818 continue;
2819
2820 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2821 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2822 {
2823 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2824 {
2825 if (suffix_len == 0)
2826 continue;
2827 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2828 && (suffix_len == -2
2829 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2830 continue;
2831 }
2832 }
2833 else
2834 {
2835 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2836 continue;
2837 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2838 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2839 suffix_len) != 0)
2840 continue;
2841 }
2842 return &spec[i];
2843 }
2844
2845 return NULL;
2846 }
2847
2848 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2849 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2850 {
2851 int i;
2852 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2853 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2854
2855 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2856 if (sec->name == NULL)
2857 return NULL;
2858
2859 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2860 spec = bed->special_sections;
2861 if (spec)
2862 {
2863 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2864 bed->special_sections,
2865 sec->use_rela_p);
2866 if (spec != NULL)
2867 return spec;
2868 }
2869
2870 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2871 return NULL;
2872
2873 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2874 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2875 return NULL;
2876
2877 spec = special_sections[i];
2878
2879 if (spec == NULL)
2880 return NULL;
2881
2882 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2883 }
2884
2885 bool
2886 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2887 {
2888 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2889 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2890 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2891
2892 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2893 if (sdata == NULL)
2894 {
2895 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2896 sizeof (*sdata));
2897 if (sdata == NULL)
2898 return false;
2899 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2900 }
2901
2902 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2903 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2904 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2905
2906 /* Set up ELF section type and flags for newly created sections, if
2907 there is an ABI mandated section. */
2908 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2909 if (ssect != NULL)
2910 {
2911 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2912 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2913 }
2914
2915 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2916 }
2917
2918 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2919
2920 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2921 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2922 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2923 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2924
2925 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2926 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2927 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2928 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2929 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2930 of combined data+bss.
2931
2932 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2933 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2934 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2935 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2936 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2937
2938 */
2939
2940 bool
2941 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2942 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2943 int hdr_index,
2944 const char *type_name)
2945 {
2946 asection *newsect;
2947 char *name;
2948 char namebuf[64];
2949 size_t len;
2950 int split;
2951 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
2952
2953 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2954 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2955 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2956
2957 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2958 {
2959 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2960 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2961 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2962 if (!name)
2963 return false;
2964 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2965 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2966 if (newsect == NULL)
2967 return false;
2968 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr / opb;
2969 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr / opb;
2970 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2971 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2972 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2973 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2974 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2975 {
2976 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2977 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2978 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2979 {
2980 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2981 may be data. */
2982 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2983 }
2984 }
2985 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2986 {
2987 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2988 }
2989 }
2990
2991 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2992 {
2993 bfd_vma align;
2994
2995 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2996 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2997 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2998 if (!name)
2999 return false;
3000 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
3001 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
3002 if (newsect == NULL)
3003 return false;
3004 newsect->vma = (hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz) / opb;
3005 newsect->lma = (hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz) / opb;
3006 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
3007 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
3008 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
3009 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
3010 align = hdr->p_align;
3011 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
3012 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
3013 {
3014 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
3015 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
3016 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
3017 }
3018 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
3019 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
3020 }
3021
3022 return true;
3023 }
3024
3025 static bool
3026 _bfd_elf_core_find_build_id (bfd *templ, bfd_vma offset)
3027 {
3028 /* The return value is ignored. Build-ids are considered optional. */
3029 if (templ->xvec->flavour == bfd_target_elf_flavour)
3030 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_core_find_build_id)
3031 (templ, offset);
3032 return false;
3033 }
3034
3035 bool
3036 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
3037 {
3038 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3039
3040 switch (hdr->p_type)
3041 {
3042 case PT_NULL:
3043 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
3044
3045 case PT_LOAD:
3046 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load"))
3047 return false;
3048 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core && abfd->build_id == NULL)
3049 _bfd_elf_core_find_build_id (abfd, hdr->p_offset);
3050 return true;
3051
3052 case PT_DYNAMIC:
3053 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
3054
3055 case PT_INTERP:
3056 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
3057
3058 case PT_NOTE:
3059 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
3060 return false;
3061 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz,
3062 hdr->p_align))
3063 return false;
3064 return true;
3065
3066 case PT_SHLIB:
3067 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
3068
3069 case PT_PHDR:
3070 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
3071
3072 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
3073 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
3074 "eh_frame_hdr");
3075
3076 case PT_GNU_STACK:
3077 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
3078
3079 case PT_GNU_RELRO:
3080 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
3081
3082 default:
3083 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3084 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3085 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
3086 }
3087 }
3088
3089 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3090 REL or RELA. */
3091
3092 Elf_Internal_Shdr *
3093 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
3094 {
3095 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
3096 {
3097 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
3098 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
3099 }
3100 else
3101 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
3102 }
3103
3104 static bool
3105 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
3106 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
3107 const char *sec_name,
3108 bool use_rela_p)
3109 {
3110 char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
3111 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
3112 if (name == NULL)
3113 return false;
3114
3115 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
3116 rel_hdr->sh_name =
3117 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
3118 false);
3119 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3120 return false;
3121
3122 return true;
3123 }
3124
3125 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3126 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3127 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3128 relocations. */
3129
3130 static bool
3131 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
3132 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
3133 const char *sec_name,
3134 bool use_rela_p,
3135 bool delay_st_name_p)
3136 {
3137 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
3138 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3139
3140 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
3141 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
3142 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
3143
3144 if (delay_st_name_p)
3145 rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3146 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
3147 use_rela_p))
3148 return false;
3149 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
3150 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
3151 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
3152 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
3153 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
3154 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3155 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3156 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3157 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3158
3159 return true;
3160 }
3161
3162 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3163
3164 int
3165 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
3166 {
3167 if ((flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_IS_COMMON)) != 0
3168 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
3169 return SHT_NOBITS;
3170 return SHT_PROGBITS;
3171 }
3172
3173 struct fake_section_arg
3174 {
3175 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
3176 bool failed;
3177 };
3178
3179 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3180
3181 static void
3182 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
3183 {
3184 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
3185 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3186 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
3187 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
3188 unsigned int sh_type;
3189 const char *name = asect->name;
3190 bool delay_st_name_p = false;
3191 bfd_vma mask;
3192
3193 if (arg->failed)
3194 {
3195 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3196 loop. */
3197 return;
3198 }
3199
3200 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
3201
3202 if (arg->link_info)
3203 {
3204 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3205 if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
3206 && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
3207 && name[1] == 'd'
3208 && name[6] == '_')
3209 {
3210 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3211 compressed. */
3212 asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
3213 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3214 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3215 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3216 delay_st_name_p = true;
3217 }
3218 }
3219 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
3220 {
3221 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3222 if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
3223 {
3224 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3225 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3226 needed. */
3227 if (name[1] == 'z')
3228 {
3229 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
3230 if (new_name == NULL)
3231 {
3232 arg->failed = true;
3233 return;
3234 }
3235 name = new_name;
3236 }
3237 }
3238 else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
3239 {
3240 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3241 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3242 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3243 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3244 char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
3245 if (new_name == NULL)
3246 {
3247 arg->failed = true;
3248 return;
3249 }
3250 BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
3251 name = new_name;
3252 }
3253 }
3254
3255 if (delay_st_name_p)
3256 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3257 else
3258 {
3259 this_hdr->sh_name
3260 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3261 name, false);
3262 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3263 {
3264 arg->failed = true;
3265 return;
3266 }
3267 }
3268
3269 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3270
3271 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3272 || asect->user_set_vma)
3273 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, asect);
3274 else
3275 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3276
3277 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3278 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
3279 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3280 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3281 if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
3282 {
3283 _bfd_error_handler
3284 /* xgettext:c-format */
3285 (_("%pB: error: alignment power %d of section `%pA' is too big"),
3286 abfd, asect->alignment_power, asect);
3287 arg->failed = true;
3288 return;
3289 }
3290 /* Set sh_addralign to the highest power of two given by alignment
3291 consistent with the section VMA. Linker scripts can force VMA. */
3292 mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power) | this_hdr->sh_addr;
3293 this_hdr->sh_addralign = mask & -mask;
3294 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3295 copy_private_section_data. */
3296
3297 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
3298 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
3299
3300 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3301 asect->flags. */
3302 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3303 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3304 else
3305 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3306
3307 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3308 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3309 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3310 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3311 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3312 {
3313 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3314 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3315 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3316 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3317 _bfd_error_handler
3318 (_("warning: section `%pA' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3319 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3320 }
3321
3322 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3323 {
3324 default:
3325 break;
3326
3327 case SHT_STRTAB:
3328 case SHT_NOTE:
3329 case SHT_NOBITS:
3330 case SHT_PROGBITS:
3331 break;
3332
3333 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3334 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3335 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3336 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
3337 break;
3338
3339 case SHT_HASH:
3340 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3341 break;
3342
3343 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3344 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3345 break;
3346
3347 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3348 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3349 break;
3350
3351 case SHT_RELA:
3352 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3353 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3354 break;
3355
3356 case SHT_REL:
3357 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3358 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3359 break;
3360
3361 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3362 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3363 break;
3364
3365 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3366 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3367 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3368 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3369 zero. */
3370 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3371 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3372 else
3373 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3374 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3375 break;
3376
3377 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3378 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3379 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3380 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3381 zero. */
3382 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3383 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3384 else
3385 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3386 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3387 break;
3388
3389 case SHT_GROUP:
3390 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3391 break;
3392
3393 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3394 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3395 break;
3396 }
3397
3398 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3399 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3400 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3401 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3402 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3403 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3404 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3405 {
3406 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3407 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3408 }
3409 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3410 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3411 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3412 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3413 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3414 {
3415 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3416 if (asect->size == 0
3417 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3418 {
3419 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3420
3421 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3422 if (o != NULL)
3423 {
3424 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3425 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3426 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3427 }
3428 }
3429 }
3430 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3431 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3432
3433 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3434 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3435 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3436 create the other. */
3437 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3438 {
3439 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3440 needed. */
3441 if (arg->link_info
3442 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3443 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3444 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3445 || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3446 {
3447 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3448 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name,
3449 false, delay_st_name_p))
3450 {
3451 arg->failed = true;
3452 return;
3453 }
3454 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3455 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name,
3456 true, delay_st_name_p))
3457 {
3458 arg->failed = true;
3459 return;
3460 }
3461 }
3462 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3463 (asect->use_rela_p
3464 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3465 name,
3466 asect->use_rela_p,
3467 delay_st_name_p))
3468 {
3469 arg->failed = true;
3470 return;
3471 }
3472 }
3473
3474 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3475 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3476 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3477 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3478 {
3479 arg->failed = true;
3480 return;
3481 }
3482
3483 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3484 {
3485 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3486 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3487 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3488 }
3489 }
3490
3491 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3492 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3493 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3494 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3495
3496 void
3497 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3498 {
3499 bool *failedptr = (bool *) failedptrarg;
3500 asection *elt, *first;
3501 unsigned char *loc;
3502 bool gas;
3503
3504 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3505 elfxx-ia64.c. */
3506 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP
3507 || sec->size == 0
3508 || *failedptr)
3509 return;
3510
3511 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3512 {
3513 unsigned long symindx = 0;
3514
3515 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3516 generic linker. */
3517 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3518 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3519
3520 if (symindx == 0)
3521 {
3522 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3523 elf_section_syms.
3524 PR 25699: A corrupt input file could contain bogus group info. */
3525 if (elf_section_syms (abfd) == NULL)
3526 {
3527 *failedptr = true;
3528 return;
3529 }
3530 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3531 }
3532 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3533 }
3534 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3535 {
3536 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3537 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3538 set until all local symbols are output. */
3539 asection *igroup;
3540 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
3541 unsigned long symndx;
3542 unsigned long extsymoff;
3543 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3544
3545 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3546 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3547 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3548 igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3549 sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3550 symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3551 extsymoff = 0;
3552 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3553 {
3554 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3555
3556 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3557 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3558 }
3559 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3560 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3561 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3562 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3563
3564 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3565 }
3566
3567 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3568 gas = true;
3569 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3570 {
3571 gas = false;
3572 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3573
3574 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3575 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3576 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3577 {
3578 *failedptr = true;
3579 return;
3580 }
3581 }
3582
3583 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3584
3585 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3586 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3587 start of the input section group. */
3588 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3589
3590 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3591 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3592 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3593 directives, not that it matters. */
3594 while (elt != NULL)
3595 {
3596 asection *s;
3597
3598 s = elt;
3599 if (!gas)
3600 s = s->output_section;
3601 if (s != NULL
3602 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3603 {
3604 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
3605 struct bfd_elf_section_data *input_elf_sec = elf_section_data (elt);
3606
3607 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3608 && (gas
3609 || (input_elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3610 && input_elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3611 {
3612 elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3613 loc -= 4;
3614 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rel.idx, loc);
3615 }
3616 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3617 && (gas
3618 || (input_elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3619 && input_elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3620 {
3621 elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3622 loc -= 4;
3623 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rela.idx, loc);
3624 }
3625 loc -= 4;
3626 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->this_idx, loc);
3627 }
3628 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3629 if (elt == first)
3630 break;
3631 }
3632
3633 loc -= 4;
3634 BFD_ASSERT (loc == sec->contents);
3635
3636 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3637 }
3638
3639 /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3640 .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3641 relocations apply. */
3642
3643 asection *
3644 _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
3645 {
3646 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3647 section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3648 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3649 && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3650 {
3651 asection *sec;
3652
3653 name = ".got.plt";
3654 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3655 if (sec != NULL)
3656 return sec;
3657 name = ".got";
3658 }
3659
3660 return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3661 }
3662
3663 /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3664
3665 static asection *
3666 elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3667 {
3668 const char *name;
3669 unsigned int type;
3670 bfd *abfd;
3671 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3672
3673 type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3674 if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3675 return NULL;
3676
3677 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3678 name = reloc_sec->name;
3679 if (!startswith (name, ".rel"))
3680 return NULL;
3681 name += 4;
3682 if (type == SHT_RELA && *name++ != 'a')
3683 return NULL;
3684
3685 abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3686 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3687 return bed->get_reloc_section (abfd, name);
3688 }
3689
3690 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3691 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3692 in here too, while we're at it. LINK_INFO will be 0 when arriving
3693 here for objcopy, and when using the generic ELF linker. */
3694
3695 static bool
3696 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3697 {
3698 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3699 asection *sec;
3700 unsigned int section_number;
3701 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3702 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3703 bool need_symtab;
3704 size_t amt;
3705
3706 section_number = 1;
3707
3708 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3709
3710 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3711 if (link_info == NULL || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
3712 {
3713 size_t reloc_count = 0;
3714
3715 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3716 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3717 {
3718 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3719
3720 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3721 {
3722 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3723 {
3724 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3725 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3726 abfd->section_count--;
3727 }
3728 else
3729 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3730 }
3731
3732 /* Count relocations. */
3733 reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
3734 }
3735
3736 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3737 if (reloc_count == 0)
3738 abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
3739 }
3740
3741 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3742 {
3743 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3744
3745 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3746 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3747 if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3748 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3749 if (d->rel.hdr)
3750 {
3751 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3752 if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3753 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3754 }
3755 else
3756 d->rel.idx = 0;
3757
3758 if (d->rela.hdr)
3759 {
3760 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3761 if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3762 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3763 }
3764 else
3765 d->rela.idx = 0;
3766 }
3767
3768 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3769 || (link_info == NULL
3770 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3771 == HAS_RELOC)));
3772 if (need_symtab)
3773 {
3774 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3775 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3776 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3777 {
3778 elf_section_list *entry;
3779
3780 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3781
3782 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
3783 entry->ndx = section_number++;
3784 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3785 entry->hdr.sh_name
3786 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3787 ".symtab_shndx", false);
3788 if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3789 return false;
3790 }
3791 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3792 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3793 }
3794
3795 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3796 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3797 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3798
3799 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3800 {
3801 /* xgettext:c-format */
3802 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: too many sections: %u"),
3803 abfd, section_number);
3804 return false;
3805 }
3806
3807 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3808 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3809
3810 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3811 indices. */
3812 amt = section_number * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *);
3813 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3814 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3815 return false;
3816
3817 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3818 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3819 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3820 {
3821 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3822 return false;
3823 }
3824
3825 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3826
3827 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3828 if (need_symtab)
3829 {
3830 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3831 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3832 {
3833 elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3834 BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3835 i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3836 entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3837 }
3838 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3839 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3840 }
3841
3842 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3843 {
3844 asection *s;
3845
3846 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3847
3848 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3849 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3850 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3851 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3852 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3853
3854 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3855
3856 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3857 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3858 the relocation entries apply. */
3859 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3860 {
3861 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3862 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3863 d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3864 }
3865 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3866 {
3867 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3868 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3869 d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3870 }
3871
3872 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3873 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3874 {
3875 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3876 /* We can now have a NULL linked section pointer.
3877 This happens when the sh_link field is 0, which is done
3878 when a linked to section is discarded but the linking
3879 section has been retained for some reason. */
3880 if (s)
3881 {
3882 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3883 if (discarded_section (s))
3884 {
3885 asection *kept;
3886 _bfd_error_handler
3887 /* xgettext:c-format */
3888 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3889 " discarded section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3890 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3891 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3892 size as the discarded one. */
3893 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3894 if (kept == NULL)
3895 {
3896 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3897 return false;
3898 }
3899 s = kept;
3900 }
3901 /* Handle objcopy. */
3902 else if (s->output_section == NULL)
3903 {
3904 _bfd_error_handler
3905 /* xgettext:c-format */
3906 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3907 " removed section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3908 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3909 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3910 return false;
3911 }
3912 s = s->output_section;
3913 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3914 }
3915 }
3916
3917 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3918 {
3919 case SHT_REL:
3920 case SHT_RELA:
3921 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3922 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3923 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3924 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3925 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3926 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3927 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3928 if (s != NULL)
3929 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3930
3931 s = elf_get_reloc_section (sec);
3932 if (s != NULL)
3933 {
3934 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3935 d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3936 }
3937 break;
3938
3939 case SHT_STRTAB:
3940 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3941 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3942 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3943 field to point to this section. */
3944 if (startswith (sec->name, ".stab")
3945 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3946 {
3947 size_t len;
3948 char *alc;
3949
3950 len = strlen (sec->name);
3951 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3952 if (alc == NULL)
3953 return false;
3954 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3955 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3956 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3957 free (alc);
3958 if (s != NULL)
3959 {
3960 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3961
3962 /* This is a .stab section. */
3963 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 12;
3964 }
3965 }
3966 break;
3967
3968 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3969 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3970 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3971 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3972 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3973 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3974 version strings. */
3975 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3976 if (s != NULL)
3977 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3978 break;
3979
3980 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3981 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3982 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3983 the version strings. */
3984 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3985 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3986 if (s != NULL)
3987 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3988 break;
3989
3990 case SHT_HASH:
3991 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3992 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3993 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3994 this hash table or version table is for. */
3995 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3996 if (s != NULL)
3997 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3998 break;
3999
4000 case SHT_GROUP:
4001 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
4002 }
4003 }
4004
4005 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
4006 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
4007 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
4008
4009 return true;
4010 }
4011
4012 static bool
4013 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4014 {
4015 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
4016 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4017 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
4018 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
4019
4020 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
4021 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_asymbol_section (sym))
4022 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_asymbol_section (sym)));
4023 }
4024
4025 /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
4026 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
4027 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
4028 the beginning of that array.
4029
4030 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
4031
4032 unsigned int
4033 _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4034 asymbol **syms, long symcount)
4035 {
4036 long src_count, dst_count = 0;
4037
4038 for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
4039 {
4040 asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
4041 char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
4042 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
4043
4044 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4045 continue;
4046
4047 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, false, false, false);
4048 if (h == NULL)
4049 continue;
4050 if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4051 continue;
4052 if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
4053 continue;
4054
4055 syms[dst_count++] = sym;
4056 }
4057
4058 syms[dst_count] = NULL;
4059
4060 return dst_count;
4061 }
4062
4063 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4064 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4065
4066 static bool
4067 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4068 {
4069 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
4070
4071 if (sym == NULL)
4072 return false;
4073
4074 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
4075 return false;
4076
4077 /* Ignore the section symbol if it isn't used. */
4078 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM_USED) == 0)
4079 return true;
4080
4081 if (sym->section == NULL)
4082 return true;
4083
4084 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (sym);
4085 return ((type_ptr != NULL
4086 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
4087 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4088 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
4089 || (sym->section->output_section != NULL
4090 && sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
4091 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
4092 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
4093 }
4094
4095 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4096 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4097
4098 static bool
4099 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
4100 {
4101 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
4102 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
4103 asymbol **sect_syms;
4104 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
4105 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
4106 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
4107 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
4108 unsigned int max_index = 0;
4109 unsigned int idx;
4110 asection *asect;
4111 asymbol **new_syms;
4112 size_t amt;
4113
4114 #ifdef DEBUG
4115 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4116 fflush (stderr);
4117 #endif
4118
4119 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4120 {
4121 if (max_index < asect->index)
4122 max_index = asect->index;
4123 }
4124
4125 max_index++;
4126 amt = max_index * sizeof (asymbol *);
4127 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4128 if (sect_syms == NULL)
4129 return false;
4130 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
4131 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
4132
4133 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4134 decided to output. */
4135 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4136 {
4137 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4138
4139 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
4140 && sym->value == 0
4141 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4142 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4143 {
4144 asection *sec = sym->section;
4145
4146 if (sec->owner != abfd)
4147 sec = sec->output_section;
4148
4149 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
4150 }
4151 }
4152
4153 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4154 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4155 {
4156 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
4157 num_globals++;
4158 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
4159 num_locals++;
4160 }
4161
4162 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4163 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4164 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4165 at least in that case. */
4166 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4167 {
4168 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4169 /* Don't include ignored section symbols. */
4170 if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4171 && sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4172 {
4173 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
4174 num_locals++;
4175 else
4176 num_globals++;
4177 }
4178 }
4179
4180 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4181 amt = (num_locals + num_globals) * sizeof (asymbol *);
4182 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4183 if (new_syms == NULL)
4184 return false;
4185
4186 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4187 {
4188 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4189 unsigned int i;
4190
4191 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4192 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4193 /* Don't include ignored section symbols. */
4194 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
4195 i = num_locals2++;
4196 else
4197 continue;
4198 new_syms[i] = sym;
4199 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4200 }
4201 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4202 {
4203 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4204 if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4205 && sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4206 {
4207 unsigned int i;
4208
4209 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
4210 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4211 i = num_locals2++;
4212 else
4213 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4214 new_syms[i] = sym;
4215 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4216 }
4217 }
4218
4219 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
4220
4221 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
4222 return true;
4223 }
4224
4225 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4226 ELF data structure. */
4227
4228 static inline file_ptr
4229 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
4230 {
4231 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
4232 }
4233
4234 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4235 required section alignment. */
4236
4237 file_ptr
4238 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
4239 file_ptr offset,
4240 bool align)
4241 {
4242 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
4243 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
4244 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
4245 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
4246 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
4247 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4248 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
4249 return offset;
4250 }
4251
4252 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4253 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4254 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4255
4256 bool
4257 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
4258 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4259 {
4260 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4261 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
4262 bool failed;
4263 struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
4264 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
4265 bool need_symtab;
4266
4267 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
4268 return true;
4269
4270 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4271 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
4272 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
4273
4274 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_init_file_header) (abfd, link_info))
4275 return false;
4276
4277 fsargs.failed = false;
4278 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
4279 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
4280 if (fsargs.failed)
4281 return false;
4282
4283 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
4284 return false;
4285
4286 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4287 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
4288 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
4289 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
4290 == HAS_RELOC)));
4291 if (need_symtab)
4292 {
4293 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4294 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
4295
4296 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p, link_info))
4297 return false;
4298 }
4299
4300 failed = false;
4301 if (link_info == NULL)
4302 {
4303 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
4304 if (failed)
4305 return false;
4306 }
4307
4308 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
4309 /* sh_name was set in init_file_header. */
4310 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
4311 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
4312 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
4313 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4314 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4315 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
4316 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
4317 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4318 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
4319
4320 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
4321 return false;
4322
4323 if (need_symtab)
4324 {
4325 file_ptr off;
4326 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4327
4328 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4329
4330 hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4331 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, true);
4332
4333 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
4334 {
4335 hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
4336 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4337 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, true);
4338 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4339 }
4340
4341 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
4342 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, true);
4343
4344 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4345
4346 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4347 out. */
4348 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
4349 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
4350 return false;
4351 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
4352 }
4353
4354 abfd->output_has_begun = true;
4355
4356 return true;
4357 }
4358
4359 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4360 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4361
4362 static bfd_size_type
4363 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4364 {
4365 size_t segs;
4366 asection *s;
4367 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4368
4369 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4370 and one for data. */
4371 segs = 2;
4372
4373 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4374 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 && s->size != 0)
4375 {
4376 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4377 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4378 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4379 targets. */
4380 segs += 2;
4381 }
4382
4383 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
4384 {
4385 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4386 ++segs;
4387 }
4388
4389 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4390 {
4391 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4392 ++segs;
4393 }
4394
4395 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4396 {
4397 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4398 ++segs;
4399 }
4400
4401 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4402 {
4403 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4404 ++segs;
4405 }
4406
4407 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
4408 NOTE_GNU_PROPERTY_SECTION_NAME);
4409 if (s != NULL && s->size != 0)
4410 {
4411 /* We need a PT_GNU_PROPERTY segment. */
4412 ++segs;
4413 }
4414
4415 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4416 {
4417 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4418 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE)
4419 {
4420 unsigned int alignment_power;
4421 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4422 ++segs;
4423 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment for all adjacent
4424 loadable SHT_NOTE sections. gABI requires that within a
4425 PT_NOTE segment (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4426 each note should have the same alignment. So we check
4427 whether the sections are correctly aligned. */
4428 alignment_power = s->alignment_power;
4429 while (s->next != NULL
4430 && s->next->alignment_power == alignment_power
4431 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4432 && elf_section_type (s->next) == SHT_NOTE)
4433 s = s->next;
4434 }
4435 }
4436
4437 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4438 {
4439 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4440 {
4441 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4442 ++segs;
4443 break;
4444 }
4445 }
4446
4447 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4448
4449 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4450 && (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind) != 0)
4451 {
4452 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4453 bfd_vma commonpagesize;
4454 unsigned int page_align_power;
4455
4456 if (info != NULL)
4457 commonpagesize = info->commonpagesize;
4458 else
4459 commonpagesize = bed->commonpagesize;
4460 page_align_power = bfd_log2 (commonpagesize);
4461 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4462 if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
4463 {
4464 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info > PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
4465 {
4466 _bfd_error_handler
4467 /* xgettext:c-format */
4468 (_("%pB: GNU_MBIND section `%pA' has invalid "
4469 "sh_info field: %d"),
4470 abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4471 continue;
4472 }
4473 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4474 if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
4475 s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
4476 segs ++;
4477 }
4478 }
4479
4480 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4481 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4482 {
4483 int a;
4484
4485 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4486 if (a == -1)
4487 abort ();
4488 segs += a;
4489 }
4490
4491 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4492 }
4493
4494 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4495
4496 Elf_Internal_Phdr *
4497 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4498 {
4499 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4500 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4501
4502 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4503 m != NULL;
4504 m = m->next, p++)
4505 {
4506 int i;
4507
4508 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4509 if (m->sections[i] == section)
4510 return p;
4511 }
4512
4513 return NULL;
4514 }
4515
4516 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4517
4518 static struct elf_segment_map *
4519 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4520 asection **sections,
4521 unsigned int from,
4522 unsigned int to,
4523 bool phdr)
4524 {
4525 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4526 unsigned int i;
4527 asection **hdrpp;
4528 size_t amt;
4529
4530 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
4531 amt += (to - from) * sizeof (asection *);
4532 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4533 if (m == NULL)
4534 return NULL;
4535 m->next = NULL;
4536 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4537 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4538 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4539 m->count = to - from;
4540
4541 if (from == 0 && phdr)
4542 {
4543 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4544 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4545 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4546 }
4547
4548 return m;
4549 }
4550
4551 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4552 on failure. */
4553
4554 struct elf_segment_map *
4555 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4556 {
4557 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4558
4559 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4560 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4561 if (m == NULL)
4562 return NULL;
4563 m->next = NULL;
4564 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4565 m->count = 1;
4566 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4567
4568 return m;
4569 }
4570
4571 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4572
4573 static bool
4574 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4575 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4576 bool remove_empty_load)
4577 {
4578 struct elf_segment_map **m;
4579 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4580
4581 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4582 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4583 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4584 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4585 removed. */
4586 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4587 while (*m)
4588 {
4589 unsigned int i, new_count;
4590
4591 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4592 {
4593 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4594 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4595 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4596 {
4597 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4598 new_count++;
4599 }
4600 }
4601 (*m)->count = new_count;
4602
4603 if (remove_empty_load
4604 && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
4605 && (*m)->count == 0
4606 && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
4607 *m = (*m)->next;
4608 else
4609 m = &(*m)->next;
4610 }
4611
4612 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4613 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4614 {
4615 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4616 return false;
4617 }
4618
4619 return true;
4620 }
4621
4622 #define IS_TBSS(s) \
4623 ((s->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4624
4625 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4626
4627 bool
4628 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4629 {
4630 unsigned int count;
4631 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4632 asection **sections = NULL;
4633 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4634 bool no_user_phdrs;
4635
4636 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4637
4638 if (info != NULL)
4639 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4640
4641 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4642 {
4643 asection *s;
4644 unsigned int i;
4645 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4646 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4647 asection *last_hdr;
4648 bfd_vma last_size;
4649 unsigned int hdr_index;
4650 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4651 asection **hdrpp;
4652 bool phdr_in_segment;
4653 bool writable;
4654 bool executable;
4655 unsigned int tls_count = 0;
4656 asection *first_tls = NULL;
4657 asection *first_mbind = NULL;
4658 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4659 size_t amt;
4660 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0; /* Bytes. */
4661 bfd_size_type phdr_size; /* Octets/bytes. */
4662 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
4663
4664 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4665
4666 amt = bfd_count_sections (abfd) * sizeof (asection *);
4667 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc (amt);
4668 if (sections == NULL)
4669 goto error_return;
4670
4671 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4672 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4673 being shifted. */
4674 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4675 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4676
4677 i = 0;
4678 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4679 {
4680 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4681 {
4682 /* target_index is unused until bfd_elf_final_link
4683 starts output of section symbols. Use it to make
4684 qsort stable. */
4685 s->target_index = i;
4686 sections[i] = s;
4687 ++i;
4688 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4689 if (((s->lma + s->size / opb) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4690 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size / opb) & addr_mask;
4691 }
4692 }
4693 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4694 count = i;
4695
4696 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4697
4698 phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4699 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4700 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4701 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4702 /* phdr_size is compared to LMA values which are in bytes. */
4703 phdr_size /= opb;
4704 if (info != NULL)
4705 maxpagesize = info->maxpagesize;
4706 else
4707 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4708 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4709 maxpagesize = 1;
4710 phdr_in_segment = info != NULL && info->load_phdrs;
4711 if (count != 0
4712 && (((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) & (maxpagesize - 1))
4713 >= (phdr_size & (maxpagesize - 1))))
4714 /* For compatibility with old scripts that may not be using
4715 SIZEOF_HEADERS, add headers when it looks like space has
4716 been left for them. */
4717 phdr_in_segment = true;
4718
4719 /* Build the mapping. */
4720 mfirst = NULL;
4721 pm = &mfirst;
4722
4723 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4724 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4725 section. */
4726 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4727 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 && s->size != 0)
4728 {
4729 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4730 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4731 if (m == NULL)
4732 goto error_return;
4733 m->next = NULL;
4734 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4735 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4736 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4737 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4738 phdr_in_segment = true;
4739 *pm = m;
4740 pm = &m->next;
4741
4742 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4743 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4744 if (m == NULL)
4745 goto error_return;
4746 m->next = NULL;
4747 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4748 m->count = 1;
4749 m->sections[0] = s;
4750
4751 *pm = m;
4752 pm = &m->next;
4753 }
4754
4755 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4756 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4757 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4758 last_hdr = NULL;
4759 last_size = 0;
4760 hdr_index = 0;
4761 writable = false;
4762 executable = false;
4763 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4764 if (dynsec != NULL
4765 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4766 dynsec = NULL;
4767
4768 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4769 phdr_in_segment = false;
4770
4771 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4772 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4773 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4774 program headers we will need. */
4775 if (phdr_in_segment && count > 0)
4776 {
4777 bfd_vma phdr_lma; /* Bytes. */
4778 bool separate_phdr = false;
4779
4780 phdr_lma = (sections[0]->lma - phdr_size) & addr_mask & -maxpagesize;
4781 if (info != NULL
4782 && info->separate_code
4783 && (sections[0]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4784 {
4785 /* If data sections should be separate from code and
4786 thus not executable, and the first section is
4787 executable then put the file and program headers in
4788 their own PT_LOAD. */
4789 separate_phdr = true;
4790 if ((((phdr_lma + phdr_size - 1) & addr_mask & -maxpagesize)
4791 == (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize)))
4792 {
4793 /* The file and program headers are currently on the
4794 same page as the first section. Put them on the
4795 previous page if we can. */
4796 if (phdr_lma >= maxpagesize)
4797 phdr_lma -= maxpagesize;
4798 else
4799 separate_phdr = false;
4800 }
4801 }
4802 if ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_lma
4803 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size)
4804 /* If file and program headers would be placed at the end
4805 of memory then it's probably better to omit them. */
4806 phdr_in_segment = false;
4807 else if (phdr_lma < wrap_to)
4808 /* If a section wraps around to where we'll be placing
4809 file and program headers, then the headers will be
4810 overwritten. */
4811 phdr_in_segment = false;
4812 else if (separate_phdr)
4813 {
4814 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, 0, 0, phdr_in_segment);
4815 if (m == NULL)
4816 goto error_return;
4817 m->p_paddr = phdr_lma * opb;
4818 m->p_vaddr_offset
4819 = (sections[0]->vma - phdr_size) & addr_mask & -maxpagesize;
4820 m->p_paddr_valid = 1;
4821 *pm = m;
4822 pm = &m->next;
4823 phdr_in_segment = false;
4824 }
4825 }
4826
4827 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4828 {
4829 asection *hdr;
4830 bool new_segment;
4831
4832 hdr = *hdrpp;
4833
4834 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4835 segment. */
4836
4837 if (last_hdr == NULL)
4838 {
4839 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4840 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4841 new_segment = false;
4842 }
4843 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4844 {
4845 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4846 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4847 segment. */
4848 new_segment = true;
4849 }
4850 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4851 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4852 {
4853 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4854 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4855 new_segment = true;
4856 }
4857 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4858 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4859 == (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4860 {
4861 /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
4862 pages onto the same memory page. */
4863 new_segment = false;
4864 }
4865 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4866 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4867 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4868 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4869 section can be included in the current segment. */
4870 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4871 + maxpagesize > last_hdr->lma)
4872 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4873 + maxpagesize <= hdr->lma))
4874 {
4875 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4876 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4877 new_segment = true;
4878 }
4879 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4880 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
4881 {
4882 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4883 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4884 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4885 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose. */
4886 new_segment = true;
4887 }
4888 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4889 {
4890 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4891 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4892 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4893 new_segment = false;
4894 }
4895 else if (info != NULL
4896 && info->separate_code
4897 && executable != ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0))
4898 {
4899 new_segment = true;
4900 }
4901 else if (! writable
4902 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4903 {
4904 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4905 segment. */
4906 new_segment = true;
4907 }
4908 else
4909 {
4910 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4911 new_segment = false;
4912 }
4913
4914 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4915 if (last_hdr != NULL
4916 && info != NULL
4917 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4918 new_segment
4919 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4920 last_hdr,
4921 new_segment);
4922
4923 if (! new_segment)
4924 {
4925 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4926 writable = true;
4927 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4928 executable = true;
4929 last_hdr = hdr;
4930 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4931 last_size = (!IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0) / opb;
4932 continue;
4933 }
4934
4935 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4936 header holding all the sections from hdr_index until hdr. */
4937
4938 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, hdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4939 if (m == NULL)
4940 goto error_return;
4941
4942 *pm = m;
4943 pm = &m->next;
4944
4945 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4946 writable = true;
4947 else
4948 writable = false;
4949
4950 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
4951 executable = false;
4952 else
4953 executable = true;
4954
4955 last_hdr = hdr;
4956 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4957 last_size = (!IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0) / opb;
4958 hdr_index = i;
4959 phdr_in_segment = false;
4960 }
4961
4962 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4963 for .tbss. */
4964 if (last_hdr != NULL
4965 && (i - hdr_index != 1
4966 || !IS_TBSS (last_hdr)))
4967 {
4968 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, hdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4969 if (m == NULL)
4970 goto error_return;
4971
4972 *pm = m;
4973 pm = &m->next;
4974 }
4975
4976 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4977 if (dynsec != NULL)
4978 {
4979 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4980 if (m == NULL)
4981 goto error_return;
4982 *pm = m;
4983 pm = &m->next;
4984 }
4985
4986 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable SHT_NOTE sections,
4987 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4988 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4989 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4990 in the output file. */
4991 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4992 {
4993 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4994 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE)
4995 {
4996 asection *s2;
4997 unsigned int alignment_power = s->alignment_power;
4998
4999 count = 1;
5000 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
5001 {
5002 if (s2->next->alignment_power == alignment_power
5003 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
5004 && elf_section_type (s2->next) == SHT_NOTE
5005 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size / opb,
5006 alignment_power)
5007 == s2->next->lma)
5008 count++;
5009 else
5010 break;
5011 }
5012 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
5013 amt += count * sizeof (asection *);
5014 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5015 if (m == NULL)
5016 goto error_return;
5017 m->next = NULL;
5018 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
5019 m->count = count;
5020 while (count > 1)
5021 {
5022 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
5023 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
5024 s = s->next;
5025 }
5026 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
5027 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
5028 *pm = m;
5029 pm = &m->next;
5030 }
5031 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
5032 {
5033 if (! tls_count)
5034 first_tls = s;
5035 tls_count++;
5036 }
5037 if (first_mbind == NULL
5038 && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
5039 first_mbind = s;
5040 }
5041
5042 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
5043 if (tls_count > 0)
5044 {
5045 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
5046 amt += tls_count * sizeof (asection *);
5047 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5048 if (m == NULL)
5049 goto error_return;
5050 m->next = NULL;
5051 m->p_type = PT_TLS;
5052 m->count = tls_count;
5053 /* Mandated PF_R. */
5054 m->p_flags = PF_R;
5055 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5056 s = first_tls;
5057 for (i = 0; i < tls_count; ++i)
5058 {
5059 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
5060 {
5061 _bfd_error_handler
5062 (_("%pB: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
5063 s = first_tls;
5064 i = 0;
5065 while (i < tls_count)
5066 {
5067 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
5068 {
5069 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %pA"), s);
5070 i++;
5071 }
5072 else
5073 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %pA"), s);
5074 s = s->next;
5075 }
5076 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5077 goto error_return;
5078 }
5079 m->sections[i] = s;
5080 s = s->next;
5081 }
5082
5083 *pm = m;
5084 pm = &m->next;
5085 }
5086
5087 if (first_mbind
5088 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
5089 && (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind) != 0)
5090 for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5091 if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
5092 && elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
5093 {
5094 /* Mandated PF_R. */
5095 unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
5096 if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
5097 p_flags |= PF_W;
5098 if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
5099 p_flags |= PF_X;
5100
5101 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
5102 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5103 if (m == NULL)
5104 goto error_return;
5105 m->next = NULL;
5106 m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
5107 + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
5108 m->count = 1;
5109 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5110 m->sections[0] = s;
5111 m->p_flags = p_flags;
5112
5113 *pm = m;
5114 pm = &m->next;
5115 }
5116
5117 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
5118 NOTE_GNU_PROPERTY_SECTION_NAME);
5119 if (s != NULL && s->size != 0)
5120 {
5121 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
5122 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5123 if (m == NULL)
5124 goto error_return;
5125 m->next = NULL;
5126 m->p_type = PT_GNU_PROPERTY;
5127 m->count = 1;
5128 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5129 m->sections[0] = s;
5130 m->p_flags = PF_R;
5131 *pm = m;
5132 pm = &m->next;
5133 }
5134
5135 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
5136 segment. */
5137 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
5138 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
5139 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
5140 {
5141 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5142 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5143 if (m == NULL)
5144 goto error_return;
5145 m->next = NULL;
5146 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
5147 m->count = 1;
5148 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
5149
5150 *pm = m;
5151 pm = &m->next;
5152 }
5153
5154 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
5155 {
5156 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5157 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5158 if (m == NULL)
5159 goto error_return;
5160 m->next = NULL;
5161 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
5162 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
5163 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
5164 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5165 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
5166 if (info->stacksize > 0)
5167 {
5168 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
5169 m->p_size_valid = 1;
5170 }
5171
5172 *pm = m;
5173 pm = &m->next;
5174 }
5175
5176 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
5177 {
5178 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
5179 {
5180 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
5181 && m->count != 0
5182 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
5183 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
5184 {
5185 i = m->count;
5186 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
5187 {
5188 if (m->sections[i]->size > 0
5189 && (m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5190 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5191 break;
5192 }
5193
5194 if (i != (unsigned) -1)
5195 break;
5196 }
5197 }
5198
5199 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5200 if (m != NULL)
5201 {
5202 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5203 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5204 if (m == NULL)
5205 goto error_return;
5206 m->next = NULL;
5207 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
5208 *pm = m;
5209 pm = &m->next;
5210 }
5211 }
5212
5213 free (sections);
5214 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
5215 }
5216
5217 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
5218 return false;
5219
5220 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5221 ++count;
5222 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5223
5224 return true;
5225
5226 error_return:
5227 free (sections);
5228 return false;
5229 }
5230
5231 /* Sort sections by address. */
5232
5233 static int
5234 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5235 {
5236 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
5237 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
5238 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
5239
5240 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5241 place the section into a segment. */
5242 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
5243 return -1;
5244 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
5245 return 1;
5246
5247 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5248 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5249 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
5250 return -1;
5251 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
5252 return 1;
5253
5254 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5255
5256 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0 \
5257 && (x)->size != 0)
5258
5259 if (TOEND (sec1))
5260 {
5261 if (!TOEND (sec2))
5262 return 1;
5263 }
5264 else if (TOEND (sec2))
5265 return -1;
5266
5267 #undef TOEND
5268
5269 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5270 before others at the same address. */
5271
5272 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
5273 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
5274
5275 if (size1 < size2)
5276 return -1;
5277 if (size1 > size2)
5278 return 1;
5279
5280 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5281 }
5282
5283 /* This qsort comparison functions sorts PT_LOAD segments first and
5284 by p_paddr, for assign_file_positions_for_load_sections. */
5285
5286 static int
5287 elf_sort_segments (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5288 {
5289 const struct elf_segment_map *m1 = *(const struct elf_segment_map **) arg1;
5290 const struct elf_segment_map *m2 = *(const struct elf_segment_map **) arg2;
5291
5292 if (m1->p_type != m2->p_type)
5293 {
5294 if (m1->p_type == PT_NULL)
5295 return 1;
5296 if (m2->p_type == PT_NULL)
5297 return -1;
5298 return m1->p_type < m2->p_type ? -1 : 1;
5299 }
5300 if (m1->includes_filehdr != m2->includes_filehdr)
5301 return m1->includes_filehdr ? -1 : 1;
5302 if (m1->no_sort_lma != m2->no_sort_lma)
5303 return m1->no_sort_lma ? -1 : 1;
5304 if (m1->p_type == PT_LOAD && !m1->no_sort_lma)
5305 {
5306 bfd_vma lma1, lma2; /* Octets. */
5307 lma1 = 0;
5308 if (m1->p_paddr_valid)
5309 lma1 = m1->p_paddr;
5310 else if (m1->count != 0)
5311 {
5312 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (m1->sections[0]->owner,
5313 m1->sections[0]);
5314 lma1 = (m1->sections[0]->lma + m1->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5315 }
5316 lma2 = 0;
5317 if (m2->p_paddr_valid)
5318 lma2 = m2->p_paddr;
5319 else if (m2->count != 0)
5320 {
5321 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (m2->sections[0]->owner,
5322 m2->sections[0]);
5323 lma2 = (m2->sections[0]->lma + m2->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5324 }
5325 if (lma1 != lma2)
5326 return lma1 < lma2 ? -1 : 1;
5327 }
5328 if (m1->idx != m2->idx)
5329 return m1->idx < m2->idx ? -1 : 1;
5330 return 0;
5331 }
5332
5333 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5334
5335 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5336 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5337 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5338 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5339 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5340 which is wrong.
5341
5342 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5343 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5344 the page size.'' */
5345 /* In other words, something like:
5346
5347 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5348 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5349 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5350 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5351 else
5352 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5353
5354 which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5355
5356 static file_ptr
5357 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
5358 {
5359 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5360 if (maxpagesize == 0)
5361 maxpagesize = 1;
5362 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
5363 }
5364
5365 static void
5366 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
5367 {
5368 unsigned int j;
5369 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
5370 char buf[32];
5371
5372 if (pt == NULL)
5373 {
5374 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
5375 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5376 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
5377 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
5378 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5379 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
5380 else
5381 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
5382 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
5383 pt = buf;
5384 }
5385 fflush (stdout);
5386 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
5387 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
5388 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
5389 putc ('\n',stderr);
5390 fflush (stderr);
5391 }
5392
5393 static bool
5394 write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
5395 {
5396 void *buf;
5397 bool ret;
5398
5399 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
5400 return false;
5401 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
5402 if (buf == NULL)
5403 return false;
5404 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
5405 free (buf);
5406 return ret;
5407 }
5408
5409 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5410 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5411 the file header. */
5412
5413 static bool
5414 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5415 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5416 {
5417 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5418 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5419 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_load_seg;
5420 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5421 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5422 file_ptr off; /* Octets. */
5423 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
5424 unsigned int alloc, actual;
5425 unsigned int i, j;
5426 struct elf_segment_map **sorted_seg_map;
5427 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
5428
5429 if (link_info == NULL
5430 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
5431 return false;
5432
5433 alloc = 0;
5434 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5435 m->idx = alloc++;
5436
5437 if (alloc)
5438 {
5439 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5440 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5441 }
5442 else
5443 {
5444 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5445 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
5446 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
5447 }
5448
5449 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
5450
5451 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
5452 {
5453 actual = alloc;
5454 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5455 }
5456 else
5457 {
5458 actual = elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5459 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
5460 == actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
5461 BFD_ASSERT (actual >= alloc);
5462 }
5463
5464 if (alloc == 0)
5465 {
5466 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5467 return true;
5468 }
5469
5470 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5471 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5472 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5473 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5474 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5475 layout.
5476 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5477 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5478 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5479 phdrs = bfd_zalloc (abfd, (actual * sizeof (*phdrs)
5480 + alloc * sizeof (*sorted_seg_map)));
5481 sorted_seg_map = (struct elf_segment_map **) (phdrs + actual);
5482 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
5483 if (phdrs == NULL)
5484 return false;
5485
5486 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), j = 0; m != NULL; m = m->next, j++)
5487 {
5488 sorted_seg_map[j] = m;
5489 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5490 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5491 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5492 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5493 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5494 if (m->count > 1
5495 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
5496 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
5497 {
5498 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5499 m->sections[i]->target_index = i;
5500 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
5501 elf_sort_sections);
5502 }
5503 }
5504 if (alloc > 1)
5505 qsort (sorted_seg_map, alloc, sizeof (*sorted_seg_map),
5506 elf_sort_segments);
5507
5508 maxpagesize = 1;
5509 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5510 {
5511 if (link_info != NULL)
5512 maxpagesize = link_info->maxpagesize;
5513 else
5514 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
5515 }
5516
5517 /* Sections must map to file offsets past the ELF file header. */
5518 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5519 /* And if one of the PT_LOAD headers doesn't include the program
5520 headers then we'll be mapping program headers in the usual
5521 position after the ELF file header. */
5522 phdr_load_seg = NULL;
5523 for (j = 0; j < alloc; j++)
5524 {
5525 m = sorted_seg_map[j];
5526 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5527 break;
5528 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5529 {
5530 phdr_load_seg = m;
5531 break;
5532 }
5533 }
5534 if (phdr_load_seg == NULL)
5535 off += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5536
5537 for (j = 0; j < alloc; j++)
5538 {
5539 asection **secpp;
5540 bfd_vma off_adjust; /* Octets. */
5541 bool no_contents;
5542
5543 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5544 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5545 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5546 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5547 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5548 m = sorted_seg_map[j];
5549 p = phdrs + m->idx;
5550 p->p_type = m->p_type;
5551 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
5552
5553 if (m->count == 0)
5554 p->p_vaddr = m->p_vaddr_offset * opb;
5555 else
5556 p->p_vaddr = (m->sections[0]->vma + m->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5557
5558 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
5559 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
5560 else if (m->count == 0)
5561 p->p_paddr = 0;
5562 else
5563 p->p_paddr = (m->sections[0]->lma + m->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5564
5565 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5566 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5567 {
5568 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5569 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5570 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5571 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5572 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5573 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5574 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5575 segment. */
5576 if (m->p_align_valid)
5577 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
5578
5579 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
5580 }
5581 else if (m->p_align_valid)
5582 p->p_align = m->p_align;
5583 else if (m->count == 0)
5584 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
5585
5586 if (m == phdr_load_seg)
5587 {
5588 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5589 p->p_offset = off;
5590 off += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5591 }
5592
5593 no_contents = false;
5594 off_adjust = 0;
5595 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5596 && m->count > 0)
5597 {
5598 bfd_size_type align; /* Bytes. */
5599 unsigned int align_power = 0;
5600
5601 if (m->p_align_valid)
5602 align = p->p_align;
5603 else
5604 {
5605 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5606 {
5607 unsigned int secalign;
5608
5609 secalign = bfd_section_alignment (*secpp);
5610 if (secalign > align_power)
5611 align_power = secalign;
5612 }
5613 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
5614 if (align < maxpagesize)
5615 align = maxpagesize;
5616 }
5617
5618 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5619 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
5620 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5621 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5622 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5623 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
5624
5625 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5626 sections. */
5627 no_contents = true;
5628 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5629 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
5630 {
5631 no_contents = false;
5632 break;
5633 }
5634
5635 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align * opb);
5636
5637 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5638 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5639 processors. */
5640 if (j != 0
5641 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
5642 && bed->no_page_alias
5643 && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
5644 && ((off & -maxpagesize)
5645 == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize)))
5646 off_adjust += maxpagesize;
5647 off += off_adjust;
5648 if (no_contents)
5649 {
5650 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5651 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5652 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5653 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5654 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5655 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5656 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5657 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5658 }
5659 else
5660 off_adjust = 0;
5661 }
5662 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5663 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5664 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5665 && m->count > 1
5666 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5667 {
5668 _bfd_error_handler
5669 (_("%pB: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5670 " is not the .dynamic section"),
5671 abfd);
5672 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5673 return false;
5674 }
5675 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5676 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5677 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5678 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5679
5680 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5681 {
5682 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5683 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5684 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5685 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5686 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5687 {
5688 if (m->count > 0)
5689 {
5690 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
5691 || (!m->p_paddr_valid
5692 && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
5693 {
5694 _bfd_error_handler
5695 (_("%pB: not enough room for program headers,"
5696 " try linking with -N"),
5697 abfd);
5698 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5699 return false;
5700 }
5701 p->p_vaddr -= off;
5702 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5703 p->p_paddr -= off;
5704 }
5705 }
5706 else if (sorted_seg_map[0]->includes_filehdr)
5707 {
5708 Elf_Internal_Phdr *filehdr = phdrs + sorted_seg_map[0]->idx;
5709 p->p_vaddr = filehdr->p_vaddr;
5710 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5711 p->p_paddr = filehdr->p_paddr;
5712 }
5713 }
5714
5715 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5716 {
5717 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5718 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5719 p->p_filesz += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5720 p->p_memsz += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5721 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5722 {
5723 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5724 {
5725 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = p->p_offset;
5726 if (m->count > 0)
5727 {
5728 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5729 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5730 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5731 }
5732 }
5733 else if (phdr_load_seg != NULL)
5734 {
5735 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr = phdrs + phdr_load_seg->idx;
5736 bfd_vma phdr_off = 0; /* Octets. */
5737 if (phdr_load_seg->includes_filehdr)
5738 phdr_off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5739 p->p_vaddr = phdr->p_vaddr + phdr_off;
5740 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5741 p->p_paddr = phdr->p_paddr + phdr_off;
5742 p->p_offset = phdr->p_offset + phdr_off;
5743 }
5744 else
5745 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5746 }
5747 }
5748
5749 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5750 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5751 {
5752 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5753 {
5754 p->p_offset = off;
5755 if (no_contents)
5756 {
5757 /* Put meaningless p_offset for PT_LOAD segments
5758 without file contents somewhere within the first
5759 page, in an attempt to not point past EOF. */
5760 bfd_size_type align = maxpagesize;
5761 if (align < p->p_align)
5762 align = p->p_align;
5763 if (align < 1)
5764 align = 1;
5765 p->p_offset = off % align;
5766 }
5767 }
5768 else
5769 {
5770 file_ptr adjust; /* Octets. */
5771
5772 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5773 if (!no_contents)
5774 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5775 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5776 }
5777 }
5778
5779 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5780 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5781 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5782 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5783 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5784 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5785 {
5786 asection *sec;
5787 bfd_size_type align;
5788 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5789
5790 sec = *secpp;
5791 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5792 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_section_alignment (sec);
5793
5794 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5795 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5796 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5797 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5798 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5799 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5800 {
5801 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr; /* Octets. */
5802 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz; /* Octets. */
5803 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma * opb; /* Octets. */
5804 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end; /* Octets. */
5805
5806 if (adjust != 0
5807 && (s_start < p_end
5808 || p_end < p_start))
5809 {
5810 _bfd_error_handler
5811 /* xgettext:c-format */
5812 (_("%pB: section %pA lma %#" PRIx64 " adjusted to %#" PRIx64),
5813 abfd, sec, (uint64_t) s_start / opb,
5814 (uint64_t) p_end / opb);
5815 adjust = 0;
5816 sec->lma = p_end / opb;
5817 }
5818 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5819
5820 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5821 {
5822 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5823 {
5824 off_adjust = 0;
5825 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5826 {
5827 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5828 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5829 zero it. */
5830 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5831 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5832 return false;
5833 }
5834 }
5835 /* We only adjust sh_offset in SHT_NOBITS sections
5836 as would seem proper for their address when the
5837 section is first in the segment. sh_offset
5838 doesn't really have any significance for
5839 SHT_NOBITS anyway, apart from a notional position
5840 relative to other sections. Historically we
5841 didn't bother with adjusting sh_offset and some
5842 programs depend on it not being adjusted. See
5843 pr12921 and pr25662. */
5844 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS || i == 0)
5845 {
5846 off += adjust;
5847 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
5848 off_adjust += adjust;
5849 }
5850 }
5851 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5852 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5853 }
5854
5855 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5856 {
5857 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5858 everything. */
5859 if (i == 0)
5860 {
5861 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5862 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5863 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5864 p->p_memsz = 0;
5865 p->p_align = 1;
5866 }
5867 else
5868 {
5869 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5870 sec->filepos = 0;
5871 sec->size = 0;
5872 sec->flags = 0;
5873 continue;
5874 }
5875 }
5876 else
5877 {
5878 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5879 {
5880 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5881 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5882 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5883 }
5884 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5885 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5886 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5887 {
5888 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5889 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5890 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5891 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5892 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5893 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5894 p_offset value. */
5895 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5896 off, align);
5897 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5898 }
5899
5900 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5901 {
5902 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5903 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5904 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5905 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5906 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5907 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5908 }
5909 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5910 {
5911 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5912 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5913
5914 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5915 normal segments. */
5916 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5917 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5918 }
5919
5920 if (align > p->p_align
5921 && !m->p_align_valid
5922 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5923 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5924 p->p_align = align;
5925 }
5926
5927 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5928 {
5929 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5930 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5931 p->p_flags |= PF_X;
5932 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5933 p->p_flags |= PF_W;
5934 }
5935 }
5936
5937 off -= off_adjust;
5938
5939 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if
5940 present, will be loaded into memory. */
5941 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR
5942 && phdr_load_seg == NULL
5943 && !(bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr != NULL
5944 && bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, phdrs, alloc)))
5945 {
5946 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
5947 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
5948 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
5949 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: error: PHDR segment not covered"
5950 " by LOAD segment"),
5951 abfd);
5952 if (link_info == NULL)
5953 return false;
5954 /* Arrange for the linker to exit with an error, deleting
5955 the output file unless --noinhibit-exec is given. */
5956 link_info->callbacks->info ("%X");
5957 }
5958
5959 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5960 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5961 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5962 {
5963 bool check_vma = true;
5964
5965 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5966 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5967 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5968 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5969 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5970 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5971 {
5972 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5973 check_vma = false;
5974 break;
5975 }
5976
5977 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5978 {
5979 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5980 asection *sec;
5981
5982 sec = m->sections[i];
5983 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5984 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5985 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5986 {
5987 _bfd_error_handler
5988 /* xgettext:c-format */
5989 (_("%pB: section `%pA' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5990 abfd, sec, j);
5991 print_segment_map (m);
5992 }
5993 }
5994 }
5995 }
5996
5997 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5998
5999 if (link_info != NULL
6000 && phdr_load_seg != NULL
6001 && phdr_load_seg->includes_filehdr)
6002 {
6003 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
6004 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
6005 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
6006
6007 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
6008 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
6009 false, false, true);
6010 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
6011 if (hash != NULL
6012 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
6013 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6014 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
6015 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
6016 {
6017 asection *s = NULL;
6018 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr = phdrs[phdr_load_seg->idx].p_vaddr / opb;
6019
6020 if (phdr_load_seg->count != 0)
6021 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
6022 s = phdr_load_seg->sections[0];
6023 else
6024 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
6025 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
6026 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD && m->count != 0)
6027 {
6028 s = m->sections[0];
6029 break;
6030 }
6031
6032 if (s != NULL)
6033 {
6034 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
6035 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
6036 }
6037 else
6038 {
6039 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
6040 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6041 }
6042
6043 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
6044 hash->def_regular = 1;
6045 hash->non_elf = 0;
6046 }
6047 }
6048
6049 return true;
6050 }
6051
6052 /* Determine if a bfd is a debuginfo file. Unfortunately there
6053 is no defined method for detecting such files, so we have to
6054 use heuristics instead. */
6055
6056 bool
6057 is_debuginfo_file (bfd *abfd)
6058 {
6059 if (abfd == NULL || bfd_get_flavour (abfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6060 return false;
6061
6062 Elf_Internal_Shdr **start_headers = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6063 Elf_Internal_Shdr **end_headers = start_headers + elf_numsections (abfd);
6064 Elf_Internal_Shdr **headerp;
6065
6066 for (headerp = start_headers; headerp < end_headers; headerp ++)
6067 {
6068 Elf_Internal_Shdr *header = * headerp;
6069
6070 /* Debuginfo files do not have any allocated SHT_PROGBITS sections.
6071 The only allocated sections are SHT_NOBITS or SHT_NOTES. */
6072 if ((header->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) == SHF_ALLOC
6073 && header->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
6074 && header->sh_type != SHT_NOTE)
6075 return false;
6076 }
6077
6078 return true;
6079 }
6080
6081 /* Assign file positions for the other sections, except for compressed debugging
6082 and other sections assigned in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load(). */
6083
6084 static bool
6085 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
6086 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6087 {
6088 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6089 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
6090 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
6091 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
6092 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
6093 struct elf_segment_map *m;
6094 file_ptr off;
6095 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
6096 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6097
6098 if (link_info != NULL)
6099 maxpagesize = link_info->maxpagesize;
6100 else
6101 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
6102 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6103 end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6104 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6105 for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
6106 {
6107 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6108
6109 hdr = *hdrpp;
6110 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6111 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
6112 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
6113 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
6114 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
6115 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
6116 {
6117 if (hdr->sh_size != 0
6118 /* PR 24717 - debuginfo files are known to be not strictly
6119 compliant with the ELF standard. In particular they often
6120 have .note.gnu.property sections that are outside of any
6121 loadable segment. This is not a problem for such files,
6122 so do not warn about them. */
6123 && ! is_debuginfo_file (abfd))
6124 _bfd_error_handler
6125 /* xgettext:c-format */
6126 (_("%pB: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
6127 abfd,
6128 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
6129 ? "*unknown*"
6130 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
6131 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
6132 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
6133 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
6134 maxpagesize);
6135 else
6136 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
6137 hdr->sh_addralign);
6138 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
6139 false);
6140 }
6141 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6142 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6143 /* We don't know the offset of these sections yet: their size has
6144 not been decided. */
6145 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6146 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
6147 || (bfd_section_is_ctf (hdr->bfd_section)
6148 && abfd->is_linker_output)))
6149 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
6150 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6151 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6152 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
6153 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
6154 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6155 else
6156 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, true);
6157 }
6158 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6159
6160 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
6161 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
6162 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
6163 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
6164 {
6165 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6166 {
6167 bfd_vma start, end; /* Bytes. */
6168 bool ok;
6169
6170 if (link_info != NULL)
6171 {
6172 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
6173 in link_info. Note that there may be padding between
6174 relro_start and the first RELRO section. */
6175 start = link_info->relro_start;
6176 end = link_info->relro_end;
6177 }
6178 else if (m->count != 0)
6179 {
6180 if (!m->p_size_valid)
6181 abort ();
6182 start = m->sections[0]->vma;
6183 end = start + m->p_size / opb;
6184 }
6185 else
6186 {
6187 start = 0;
6188 end = 0;
6189 }
6190
6191 ok = false;
6192 if (start < end)
6193 {
6194 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
6195 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
6196 unsigned int i;
6197
6198 /* Find a LOAD segment containing a section in the RELRO
6199 segment. */
6200 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
6201 lm != NULL;
6202 lm = lm->next, lp++)
6203 {
6204 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
6205 && lm->count != 0
6206 && (lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->vma
6207 + (!IS_TBSS (lm->sections[lm->count - 1])
6208 ? lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->size / opb
6209 : 0)) > start
6210 && lm->sections[0]->vma < end)
6211 break;
6212 }
6213
6214 if (lm != NULL)
6215 {
6216 /* Find the section starting the RELRO segment. */
6217 for (i = 0; i < lm->count; i++)
6218 {
6219 asection *s = lm->sections[i];
6220 if (s->vma >= start
6221 && s->vma < end
6222 && s->size != 0)
6223 break;
6224 }
6225
6226 if (i < lm->count)
6227 {
6228 p->p_vaddr = lm->sections[i]->vma * opb;
6229 p->p_paddr = lm->sections[i]->lma * opb;
6230 p->p_offset = lm->sections[i]->filepos;
6231 p->p_memsz = end * opb - p->p_vaddr;
6232 p->p_filesz = p->p_memsz;
6233
6234 /* The RELRO segment typically ends a few bytes
6235 into .got.plt but other layouts are possible.
6236 In cases where the end does not match any
6237 loaded section (for instance is in file
6238 padding), trim p_filesz back to correspond to
6239 the end of loaded section contents. */
6240 if (p->p_filesz > lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr)
6241 p->p_filesz = lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr;
6242
6243 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are
6244 valid. The gold linker generates RW/4 for
6245 the PT_GNU_RELRO section. It is better for
6246 objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
6247 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate
6248 debug files. */
6249 if (!m->p_align_valid)
6250 p->p_align = 1;
6251 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
6252 p->p_flags = PF_R;
6253 ok = true;
6254 }
6255 }
6256 }
6257 if (link_info != NULL)
6258 BFD_ASSERT (ok);
6259 if (!ok)
6260 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
6261 }
6262 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
6263 {
6264 if (m->p_size_valid)
6265 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
6266 }
6267 else if (m->count != 0)
6268 {
6269 unsigned int i;
6270
6271 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
6272 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
6273 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
6274 {
6275 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
6276 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
6277 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
6278 {
6279 m->count = 0;
6280 continue;
6281 }
6282
6283 if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
6284 {
6285 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
6286 _bfd_error_handler
6287 (_("%pB: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
6288 "and/or program header"),
6289 abfd, (int) (p - phdrs));
6290 return false;
6291 }
6292
6293 p->p_filesz = 0;
6294 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
6295 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
6296 {
6297 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
6298 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
6299 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
6300 {
6301 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
6302 + hdr->sh_size);
6303 /* NB: p_memsz of the loadable PT_NOTE segment
6304 should be the same as p_filesz. */
6305 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE
6306 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
6307 p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
6308 break;
6309 }
6310 }
6311 }
6312 }
6313 }
6314
6315 return true;
6316 }
6317
6318 static elf_section_list *
6319 find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
6320 {
6321 for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
6322 if (list->ndx == i)
6323 break;
6324 return list;
6325 }
6326
6327 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
6328 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
6329 VMAs must be known before this is called.
6330
6331 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
6332 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and those that
6333 bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are stored in a normal
6334 bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't consider the former sort
6335 here, unless they form part of the loadable image. Reloc sections not
6336 assigned here (and compressed debugging sections and CTF sections which
6337 nothing else in the file can rely upon) will be handled later by
6338 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
6339
6340 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
6341
6342 static bool
6343 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
6344 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6345 {
6346 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
6347 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6348 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6349 unsigned int alloc;
6350
6351 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
6352 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
6353 {
6354 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6355 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6356 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
6357 unsigned int i;
6358 file_ptr off;
6359
6360 /* Start after the ELF header. */
6361 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
6362
6363 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6364 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6365 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6366 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
6367 {
6368 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6369
6370 hdr = *hdrpp;
6371 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6372 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6373 /* Do not assign offsets for these sections yet: we don't know
6374 their sizes. */
6375 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6376 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
6377 || (bfd_section_is_ctf (hdr->bfd_section)
6378 && abfd->is_linker_output)))
6379 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
6380 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6381 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6382 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
6383 || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
6384 {
6385 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6386 }
6387 else
6388 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, true);
6389 }
6390
6391 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6392 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = 0;
6393 }
6394 else
6395 {
6396 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6397 assignment of sections to segments. */
6398 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6399 return false;
6400
6401 /* And for non-load sections. */
6402 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6403 return false;
6404 }
6405
6406 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_headers) (abfd, link_info))
6407 return false;
6408
6409 /* Write out the program headers. */
6410 alloc = i_ehdrp->e_phnum;
6411 if (alloc != 0)
6412 {
6413 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_ehdrp->e_phoff, SEEK_SET) != 0
6414 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
6415 return false;
6416 }
6417
6418 return true;
6419 }
6420
6421 bool
6422 _bfd_elf_init_file_header (bfd *abfd,
6423 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6424 {
6425 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6426 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
6427 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6428
6429 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6430
6431 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6432 if (shstrtab == NULL)
6433 return false;
6434
6435 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
6436
6437 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
6438 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
6439 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
6440 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
6441
6442 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
6443 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
6444 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
6445 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
6446
6447 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6448 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
6449 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
6450 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6451 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
6452 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
6453 else
6454 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
6455
6456 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
6457 {
6458 case bfd_arch_unknown:
6459 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
6460 break;
6461
6462 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6463 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6464 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6465 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6466 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6467 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6468 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6469 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6470 default:
6471 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
6472 }
6473
6474 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
6475 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
6476
6477 /* No program header, for now. */
6478 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6479 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6480 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
6481
6482 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6483 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
6484 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
6485
6486 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
6487 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", false);
6488 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
6489 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", false);
6490 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
6491 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", false);
6492 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6493 || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6494 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
6495 return false;
6496
6497 return true;
6498 }
6499
6500 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=.
6501
6502 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6503 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6504 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6505 changed or the programs updated. */
6506
6507 bool
6508 _bfd_elf_modify_headers (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6509 {
6510 if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
6511 {
6512 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (obfd);
6513 unsigned int num_segments = i_ehdrp->e_phnum;
6514 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (obfd);
6515 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = tdata->phdr;
6516 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
6517
6518 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6519 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
6520 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
6521 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
6522 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6523
6524 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6525 segments is non-zero. */
6526 if (p_vaddr)
6527 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6528 }
6529 return true;
6530 }
6531
6532 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6533 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6534
6535 static bool
6536 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
6537 {
6538 file_ptr off;
6539 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
6540 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
6541 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
6542 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6543
6544 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6545
6546 shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6547 end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6548 for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
6549 {
6550 shdrp = *shdrpp;
6551 if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
6552 {
6553 asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
6554 bool is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
6555 || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
6556 bool is_ctf = sec && bfd_section_is_ctf (sec);
6557 if (is_rel
6558 || is_ctf
6559 || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
6560 {
6561 if (!is_rel && !is_ctf)
6562 {
6563 const char *name = sec->name;
6564 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
6565
6566 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6567 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
6568 shdrp->contents))
6569 return false;
6570
6571 if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6572 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
6573 {
6574 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6575 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6576 char *new_name
6577 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
6578 if (new_name == NULL)
6579 return false;
6580 name = new_name;
6581 }
6582 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6583 if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
6584 abort ();
6585 shdrp->sh_name
6586 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6587 name, false);
6588 d = elf_section_data (sec);
6589
6590 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6591 if (d->rel.hdr
6592 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6593 d->rel.hdr,
6594 name, false))
6595 return false;
6596 if (d->rela.hdr
6597 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6598 d->rela.hdr,
6599 name, true))
6600 return false;
6601
6602 /* Update section size and contents. */
6603 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6604 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6605 shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
6606 }
6607 else if (is_ctf)
6608 {
6609 /* Update section size and contents. */
6610 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6611 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6612 }
6613
6614 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
6615 off,
6616 true);
6617 }
6618 }
6619 }
6620
6621 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6622 compressed. */
6623 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6624 shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
6625 shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6626 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, true);
6627
6628 /* Place the section headers. */
6629 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6630 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6631 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
6632 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
6633 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
6634 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6635
6636 return true;
6637 }
6638
6639 bool
6640 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
6641 {
6642 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6643 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
6644 bool failed;
6645 unsigned int count, num_sec;
6646 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
6647
6648 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
6649 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
6650 return false;
6651 /* Do not rewrite ELF data when the BFD has been opened for update.
6652 abfd->output_has_begun was set to TRUE on opening, so creation of new
6653 sections, and modification of existing section sizes was restricted.
6654 This means the ELF header, program headers and section headers can't have
6655 changed.
6656 If the contents of any sections has been modified, then those changes have
6657 already been written to the BFD. */
6658 else if (abfd->direction == both_direction)
6659 {
6660 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
6661 return true;
6662 }
6663
6664 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6665
6666 failed = false;
6667 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
6668 if (failed)
6669 return false;
6670
6671 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
6672 return false;
6673
6674 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6675 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6676 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
6677 {
6678 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
6679 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6680 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
6681 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
6682 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]))
6683 return false;
6684 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
6685 {
6686 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
6687
6688 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6689 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
6690 return false;
6691 }
6692 }
6693
6694 /* Write out the section header names. */
6695 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
6696 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
6697 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6698 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
6699 return false;
6700
6701 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd))
6702 return false;
6703
6704 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
6705 return false;
6706
6707 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6708 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
6709 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
6710
6711 return true;
6712 }
6713
6714 bool
6715 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
6716 {
6717 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6718 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
6719 }
6720
6721 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6722
6723 unsigned int
6724 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
6725 {
6726 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6727 unsigned int sec_index;
6728
6729 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
6730 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
6731 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
6732
6733 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
6734 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
6735 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
6736 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
6737 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
6738 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
6739 else
6740 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
6741
6742 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6743 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
6744 {
6745 int retval = sec_index;
6746
6747 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
6748 return retval;
6749 }
6750
6751 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
6752 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
6753
6754 return sec_index;
6755 }
6756
6757 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6758 on error. */
6759
6760 int
6761 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
6762 {
6763 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
6764 int idx;
6765 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
6766
6767 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6768 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6769 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6770 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6771 input sections rather than the output section. */
6772 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
6773 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6774 && asym_ptr->section)
6775 {
6776 asection *sec;
6777 int indx;
6778
6779 sec = asym_ptr->section;
6780 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
6781 sec = sec->output_section;
6782 if (sec->owner == abfd
6783 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
6784 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
6785 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
6786 }
6787
6788 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
6789
6790 if (idx == 0)
6791 {
6792 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6793 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6794 _bfd_error_handler
6795 /* xgettext:c-format */
6796 (_("%pB: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6797 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
6798 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
6799 return -1;
6800 }
6801
6802 #if DEBUG & 4
6803 {
6804 fprintf (stderr,
6805 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6806 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags);
6807 fflush (stderr);
6808 }
6809 #endif
6810
6811 return idx;
6812 }
6813
6814 /* Rewrite program header information. */
6815
6816 static bool
6817 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
6818 {
6819 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6820 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6821 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6822 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6823 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6824 asection *section;
6825 unsigned int i;
6826 unsigned int num_segments;
6827 bool phdr_included = false;
6828 bool p_paddr_valid;
6829 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6830 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6831 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6832 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (ibfd, NULL);
6833
6834 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6835 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6836
6837 map_first = NULL;
6838 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6839
6840 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6841
6842 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6843 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6844 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6845 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6846
6847 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6848 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6849 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6850 ? section->size : 0)
6851
6852 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6853 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6854 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment, opb) \
6855 (section->vma * (opb) >= segment->p_vaddr \
6856 && (section->vma * (opb) + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6857 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6858
6859 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6860 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6861 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base, opb) \
6862 (section->lma * (opb) >= base \
6863 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) / (opb) >= section->lma) \
6864 && (section->lma * (opb) + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6865 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6866
6867 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6868 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6869 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6870 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6871 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6872 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6873 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6874
6875 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6876 etc. */
6877 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6878 (IS_NOTE (p, s) \
6879 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6880 && s->vma == 0 \
6881 && s->lma == 0)
6882
6883 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6884 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6885 p_memsz set to 0. */
6886 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6887 (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
6888 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6889 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6890 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6891 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6892 && s->size > 0 \
6893 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6894 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6895 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6896
6897 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6898 A section will be included if:
6899 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6900 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6901 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6902 segment.
6903 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6904 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6905 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6906 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6907 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6908 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6909 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6910 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed, opb) \
6911 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6912 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr, opb) \
6913 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment, opb)) \
6914 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6915 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6916 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6917 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6918 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6919 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6920 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6921 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6922 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6923 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6924 || (segment->p_paddr \
6925 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma * (opb) \
6926 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma * (opb)) \
6927 || (strcmp (bfd_section_name (section), ".dynamic") == 0)) \
6928 && (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD || !section->segment_mark))
6929
6930 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6931 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6932 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed, opb) \
6933 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb) \
6934 && section->output_section != NULL)
6935
6936 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6937 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6938 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6939
6940 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6941 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6942 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6943 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6944 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6945 LMA. */
6946 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6947 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6948 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6949 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6950 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6951
6952 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6953 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6954 section->segment_mark = false;
6955
6956 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6957 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6958 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6959 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6960 p_paddr_valid = false;
6961 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6962 i < num_segments;
6963 i++, segment++)
6964 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6965 {
6966 p_paddr_valid = true;
6967 break;
6968 }
6969
6970 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6971 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6972 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6973 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6974 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6975 i < num_segments;
6976 i++, segment++)
6977 {
6978 unsigned int j;
6979 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6980
6981 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6982 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6983 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6984 {
6985 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6986 assignment code will work. */
6987 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma * opb;
6988 break;
6989 }
6990
6991 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6992 {
6993 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6994 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6995 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6996 continue;
6997 }
6998
6999 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
7000 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
7001 {
7002 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
7003
7004 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
7005 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
7006 continue;
7007
7008 /* Merge the two segments together. */
7009 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
7010 {
7011 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
7012 SEGMENT. */
7013 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
7014 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
7015
7016 if (extra_length > 0)
7017 {
7018 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
7019 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
7020 }
7021
7022 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
7023
7024 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
7025 i = 0;
7026 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7027 break;
7028 }
7029 else
7030 {
7031 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
7032 SEGMENT2. */
7033 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
7034 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
7035
7036 if (extra_length > 0)
7037 {
7038 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
7039 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
7040 }
7041
7042 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
7043 }
7044 }
7045 }
7046
7047 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
7048 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7049 i < num_segments;
7050 i++, segment++)
7051 {
7052 unsigned int section_count;
7053 asection **sections;
7054 asection *output_section;
7055 unsigned int isec;
7056 asection *matching_lma;
7057 asection *suggested_lma;
7058 unsigned int j;
7059 size_t amt;
7060 asection *first_section;
7061
7062 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
7063 continue;
7064
7065 first_section = NULL;
7066 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
7067 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7068 section != NULL;
7069 section = section->next)
7070 {
7071 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
7072 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
7073 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb))
7074 {
7075 if (first_section == NULL)
7076 first_section = section;
7077 if (section->output_section != NULL)
7078 ++section_count;
7079 }
7080 }
7081
7082 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7083 all of the sections we have selected. */
7084 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7085 amt += section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7086 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7087 if (map == NULL)
7088 return false;
7089
7090 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
7091 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
7092 map->next = NULL;
7093 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7094 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7095 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7096
7097 if (map->p_type == PT_LOAD
7098 && (ibfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
7099 && maxpagesize > 1
7100 && segment->p_align > 1)
7101 {
7102 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7103 if (segment->p_align > maxpagesize)
7104 map->p_align = maxpagesize;
7105 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7106 }
7107
7108 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
7109 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
7110 output segment. */
7111 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
7112 {
7113 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7114 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7115 }
7116
7117 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7118 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7119 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7120 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7121 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7122
7123 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7124 {
7125 map->includes_phdrs =
7126 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7127 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7128 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7129 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7130
7131 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7132 phdr_included = true;
7133 }
7134
7135 if (section_count == 0)
7136 {
7137 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
7138 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
7139 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
7140 a warning is produced.
7141 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
7142 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
7143 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
7144 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7145 && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
7146 /* xgettext:c-format */
7147 _bfd_error_handler
7148 (_("%pB: warning: empty loadable segment detected"
7149 " at vaddr=%#" PRIx64 ", is this intentional?"),
7150 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_vaddr);
7151
7152 map->p_vaddr_offset = segment->p_vaddr / opb;
7153 map->count = 0;
7154 *pointer_to_map = map;
7155 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7156
7157 continue;
7158 }
7159
7160 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
7161 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
7162 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
7163 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
7164
7165 1. None of the sections have been moved.
7166 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
7167 input BFD.
7168
7169 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
7170 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
7171 of the first section.
7172
7173 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
7174 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
7175 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
7176 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
7177 have to be created to contain the other sections.
7178
7179 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
7180 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
7181 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
7182 or segments to contain the other sections.
7183
7184 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
7185 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
7186 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
7187
7188 amt = section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7189 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc (amt);
7190 if (sections == NULL)
7191 return false;
7192
7193 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
7194 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
7195 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
7196 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
7197 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
7198 more to do. */
7199 isec = 0;
7200 matching_lma = NULL;
7201 suggested_lma = NULL;
7202
7203 for (section = first_section, j = 0;
7204 section != NULL;
7205 section = section->next)
7206 {
7207 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb))
7208 {
7209 output_section = section->output_section;
7210
7211 sections[j++] = section;
7212
7213 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
7214 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
7215 correct value. Note - some backends require that
7216 p_paddr be left as zero. */
7217 if (!p_paddr_valid
7218 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
7219 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7220 && isec == 0
7221 && output_section->lma != 0
7222 && (align_power (segment->p_vaddr
7223 + (map->includes_filehdr
7224 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7225 + (map->includes_phdrs
7226 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7227 : 0),
7228 output_section->alignment_power * opb)
7229 == (output_section->vma * opb)))
7230 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
7231
7232 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
7233 LMA address of the output section. */
7234 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr,
7235 opb)
7236 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
7237 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7238 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment, opb)))
7239 {
7240 if (matching_lma == NULL
7241 || output_section->lma < matching_lma->lma)
7242 matching_lma = output_section;
7243
7244 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
7245 then it does not overlap any other section within that
7246 segment. */
7247 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
7248 }
7249 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7250 suggested_lma = output_section;
7251
7252 if (j == section_count)
7253 break;
7254 }
7255 }
7256
7257 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
7258
7259 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
7260 if necessary. */
7261 if (isec == section_count)
7262 {
7263 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
7264 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
7265 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
7266 program header in the input BFD. */
7267 map->count = section_count;
7268 *pointer_to_map = map;
7269 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7270
7271 if (p_paddr_valid
7272 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7273 {
7274 bfd_vma hdr_size = 0;
7275 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7276 hdr_size = iehdr->e_ehsize;
7277 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7278 hdr_size += iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7279
7280 /* Account for padding before the first section in the
7281 segment. */
7282 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((map->p_paddr + hdr_size) / opb
7283 - matching_lma->lma);
7284 }
7285
7286 free (sections);
7287 continue;
7288 }
7289 else
7290 {
7291 /* Change the current segment's physical address to match
7292 the LMA of the first section that fitted, or if no
7293 section fitted, the first section. */
7294 if (matching_lma == NULL)
7295 matching_lma = suggested_lma;
7296
7297 map->p_paddr = matching_lma->lma * opb;
7298
7299 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
7300 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
7301 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7302 {
7303 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7304
7305 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
7306 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
7307 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
7308 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
7309 offset when we know the correct value. */
7310 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
7311 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
7312 }
7313
7314 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7315 {
7316 bfd_vma align = (bfd_vma) 1 << matching_lma->alignment_power;
7317 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
7318 /* We've subtracted off the size of headers from the
7319 first section lma, but there may have been some
7320 alignment padding before that section too. Try to
7321 account for that by adjusting the segment lma down to
7322 the same alignment. */
7323 if (segment->p_align != 0 && segment->p_align < align)
7324 align = segment->p_align;
7325 map->p_paddr &= -(align * opb);
7326 }
7327 }
7328
7329 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
7330 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
7331 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
7332 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
7333 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
7334 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
7335 the loop. */
7336 isec = 0;
7337 do
7338 {
7339 map->count = 0;
7340 suggested_lma = NULL;
7341
7342 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
7343 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
7344 {
7345 section = sections[j];
7346
7347 if (section == NULL)
7348 continue;
7349
7350 output_section = section->output_section;
7351
7352 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
7353
7354 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr,
7355 opb)
7356 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
7357 {
7358 if (map->count == 0)
7359 {
7360 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7361 the beginning of the segment, then something is
7362 wrong. */
7363 if (align_power (map->p_paddr
7364 + (map->includes_filehdr
7365 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7366 + (map->includes_phdrs
7367 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7368 : 0),
7369 output_section->alignment_power * opb)
7370 != output_section->lma * opb)
7371 goto sorry;
7372 }
7373 else
7374 {
7375 asection *prev_sec;
7376
7377 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
7378
7379 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7380 and the start of this section is more than
7381 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7382 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
7383 maxpagesize)
7384 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
7385 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
7386 > output_section->lma))
7387 {
7388 if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7389 suggested_lma = output_section;
7390
7391 continue;
7392 }
7393 }
7394
7395 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
7396 ++isec;
7397 sections[j] = NULL;
7398 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
7399 section->segment_mark = true;
7400 }
7401 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7402 suggested_lma = output_section;
7403 }
7404
7405 /* PR 23932. A corrupt input file may contain sections that cannot
7406 be assigned to any segment - because for example they have a
7407 negative size - or segments that do not contain any sections.
7408 But there are also valid reasons why a segment can be empty.
7409 So allow a count of zero. */
7410
7411 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7412 *pointer_to_map = map;
7413 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7414
7415 if (isec < section_count)
7416 {
7417 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7418 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7419 and carry on looping. */
7420 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7421 amt += section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7422 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7423 if (map == NULL)
7424 {
7425 free (sections);
7426 return false;
7427 }
7428
7429 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7430 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7431 not yet been assigned. */
7432 map->next = NULL;
7433 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7434 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7435 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7436 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma->lma * opb;
7437 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7438 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
7439 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7440 }
7441
7442 continue;
7443 sorry:
7444 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry);
7445 free (sections);
7446 return false;
7447 }
7448 while (isec < section_count);
7449
7450 free (sections);
7451 }
7452
7453 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7454
7455 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7456 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7457 the offset if necessary. */
7458 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
7459 {
7460 unsigned int count;
7461
7462 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7463 count++;
7464
7465 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
7466 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
7467 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7468
7469 for (map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7470 if (map->p_type == PT_PHDR)
7471 {
7472 bfd_vma adjust
7473 = phdr_adjust_seg->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0;
7474 map->p_paddr = phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr + adjust;
7475 break;
7476 }
7477 }
7478
7479 #undef SEGMENT_END
7480 #undef SECTION_SIZE
7481 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7482 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7483 #undef IS_NOTE
7484 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7485 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7486 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7487 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7488 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7489 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7490 return true;
7491 }
7492
7493 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7494
7495 static bool
7496 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7497 {
7498 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
7499 struct elf_segment_map *map;
7500 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
7501 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
7502 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7503 unsigned int i;
7504 unsigned int num_segments;
7505 bool phdr_included = false;
7506 bool p_paddr_valid;
7507 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (ibfd, NULL);
7508
7509 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
7510
7511 map_first = NULL;
7512 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
7513
7514 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7515 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7516 p_paddr_valid = false;
7517 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7518 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7519 i < num_segments;
7520 i++, segment++)
7521 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
7522 {
7523 p_paddr_valid = true;
7524 break;
7525 }
7526
7527 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7528 i < num_segments;
7529 i++, segment++)
7530 {
7531 asection *section;
7532 unsigned int section_count;
7533 size_t amt;
7534 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7535 asection *first_section = NULL;
7536 asection *lowest_section;
7537
7538 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7539 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7540 section != NULL;
7541 section = section->next)
7542 {
7543 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7544 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7545 {
7546 if (first_section == NULL)
7547 first_section = section;
7548 section_count++;
7549 }
7550 }
7551
7552 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7553 all of the sections we have selected. */
7554 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7555 amt += section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7556 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7557 if (map == NULL)
7558 return false;
7559
7560 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7561 input segment. */
7562 map->next = NULL;
7563 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7564 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7565 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7566 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7567 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7568 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7569 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7570 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
7571
7572 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
7573 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
7574 {
7575 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7576 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7577 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7578 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7579 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7580 systems. */
7581 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
7582 map->p_size_valid = 1;
7583 }
7584
7585 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7586 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7587 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7588 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7589
7590 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7591 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7592 {
7593 map->includes_phdrs =
7594 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7595 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7596 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7597 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7598
7599 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7600 phdr_included = true;
7601 }
7602
7603 lowest_section = NULL;
7604 if (section_count != 0)
7605 {
7606 unsigned int isec = 0;
7607
7608 for (section = first_section;
7609 section != NULL;
7610 section = section->next)
7611 {
7612 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7613 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7614 {
7615 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
7616 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7617 {
7618 bfd_vma seg_off;
7619
7620 if (lowest_section == NULL
7621 || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
7622 lowest_section = section;
7623
7624 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7625 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7626 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7627 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7628 invalid. */
7629 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7630 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
7631 else
7632 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
7633 if (section->lma * opb - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
7634 map->p_paddr_valid = false;
7635 }
7636 if (isec == section_count)
7637 break;
7638 }
7639 }
7640 }
7641
7642 if (section_count == 0)
7643 map->p_vaddr_offset = segment->p_vaddr / opb;
7644 else if (map->p_paddr_valid)
7645 {
7646 /* Account for padding before the first section in the segment. */
7647 bfd_vma hdr_size = 0;
7648 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7649 hdr_size = iehdr->e_ehsize;
7650 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7651 hdr_size += iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7652
7653 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((map->p_paddr + hdr_size) / opb
7654 - (lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0));
7655 }
7656
7657 map->count = section_count;
7658 *pointer_to_map = map;
7659 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7660 }
7661
7662 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7663 return true;
7664 }
7665
7666 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7667 information. */
7668
7669 static bool
7670 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7671 {
7672 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
7673
7674 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7675 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7676 return true;
7677
7678 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
7679 return true;
7680
7681 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7682 {
7683 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7684 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7685 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7686 asection *section, *osec;
7687 unsigned int i, num_segments;
7688 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7689 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7690
7691 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
7692
7693 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7694 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7695 goto rewrite;
7696
7697 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7698 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7699 section = section->next)
7700 section->segment_mark = false;
7701
7702 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7703 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7704 i < num_segments;
7705 i++, segment++)
7706 {
7707 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7708 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7709 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7710 map in this case. */
7711 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
7712 && segment->p_memsz == 0
7713 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
7714 goto rewrite;
7715
7716 for (section = ibfd->sections;
7717 section != NULL; section = section->next)
7718 {
7719 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7720 from the input BFD. */
7721 osec = section->output_section;
7722 if (osec)
7723 osec->segment_mark = true;
7724
7725 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7726 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7727 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7728 {
7729 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7730 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7731 if (osec == NULL
7732 || section->flags != osec->flags
7733 || section->lma != osec->lma
7734 || section->vma != osec->vma
7735 || section->size != osec->size
7736 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
7737 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
7738 goto rewrite;
7739 }
7740 }
7741 }
7742
7743 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7744 input BFD. */
7745 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7746 section = section->next)
7747 {
7748 if (!section->segment_mark)
7749 goto rewrite;
7750 else
7751 section->segment_mark = false;
7752 }
7753
7754 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7755 }
7756
7757 rewrite:
7758 maxpagesize = 0;
7759 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7760 {
7761 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7762 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7763 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7764 unsigned int i;
7765 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7766
7767 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7768 i < num_segments;
7769 i++, segment++)
7770 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7771 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
7772 {
7773 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7774 if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
7775 /* xgettext:c-format */
7776 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: segment alignment of %#"
7777 PRIx64 " is too large"),
7778 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_align);
7779 else
7780 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
7781 }
7782 }
7783 if (maxpagesize == 0)
7784 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
7785
7786 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd, maxpagesize);
7787 }
7788
7789 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7790
7791 bool
7792 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7793 asection *isec,
7794 bfd *obfd,
7795 asection *osec,
7796 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7797
7798 {
7799 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7800 bool final_link = (link_info != NULL
7801 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
7802
7803 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7804 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7805 return true;
7806
7807 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
7808
7809 /* If this is a known ABI section, ELF section type and flags may
7810 have been set up when OSEC was created. For normal sections we
7811 allow the user to override the type and flags other than
7812 SHF_MASKOS and SHF_MASKPROC. */
7813 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_PROGBITS
7814 || elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NOTE
7815 || elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NOBITS)
7816 elf_section_type (osec) = SHT_NULL;
7817 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, copy the ELF section type from
7818 the input file if the BFD section flags are the same. (If they
7819 are different the user may be doing something like
7820 "objcopy --set-section-flags .text=alloc,data".) For a final
7821 link allow some flags that the linker clears to differ. */
7822 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
7823 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
7824 || (final_link
7825 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
7826 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
7827 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
7828
7829 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7830 elf_section_flags (osec) = (elf_section_flags (isec)
7831 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
7832
7833 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7834 if ((elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind) != 0
7835 && elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
7836 elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
7837 = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
7838
7839 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7840 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7841 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7842 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7843 if ((link_info == NULL
7844 || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
7845 && (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7846 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0))
7847 {
7848 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7849 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7850 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7851 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7852 }
7853
7854 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7855 if (!final_link && (ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7856 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7857 & SHF_COMPRESSED);
7858
7859 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7860
7861 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7862 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7863 may be NULL at this point. */
7864 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7865 {
7866 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7867 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7868 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7869 }
7870
7871 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7872
7873 return true;
7874 }
7875
7876 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7877 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7878
7879 bool
7880 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7881 asection *isec,
7882 bfd *obfd,
7883 asection *osec)
7884 {
7885 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7886
7887 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7888 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7889 return true;
7890
7891 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7892 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7893
7894 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7895
7896 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7897 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7898 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7899 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7900 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7901
7902 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7903 NULL);
7904 }
7905
7906 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7907 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7908 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7909 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7910 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7911 from the linker. */
7912
7913 bool
7914 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7915 {
7916 asection *isec;
7917
7918 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7919 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7920 {
7921 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7922 asection *s = first;
7923 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7924
7925 while (s != NULL)
7926 {
7927 /* If this member section is being output but the
7928 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7929 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7930 if (s->output_section != discarded
7931 && isec->output_section == discarded)
7932 {
7933 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7934 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7935 }
7936 else
7937 {
7938 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
7939 if (s->output_section == discarded
7940 && isec->output_section != discarded)
7941 {
7942 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being
7943 output but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust
7944 its size. */
7945 removed += 4;
7946 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
7947 && (elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7948 removed += 4;
7949 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
7950 && (elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7951 removed += 4;
7952 }
7953 else
7954 {
7955 /* Also adjust for zero-sized relocation member
7956 section. */
7957 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
7958 && elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_size == 0)
7959 removed += 4;
7960 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
7961 && elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_size == 0)
7962 removed += 4;
7963 }
7964 }
7965 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7966 if (s == first)
7967 break;
7968 }
7969 if (removed != 0)
7970 {
7971 if (discarded != NULL)
7972 {
7973 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7974 adjust the input section size. */
7975 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7976 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7977 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7978 if (isec->size <= 4)
7979 {
7980 isec->size = 0;
7981 isec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7982 }
7983 }
7984 else
7985 {
7986 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7987 objcopy. */
7988 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7989 if (isec->output_section->size <= 4)
7990 {
7991 isec->output_section->size = 0;
7992 isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7993 }
7994 }
7995 }
7996 }
7997
7998 return true;
7999 }
8000
8001 /* Copy private header information. */
8002
8003 bool
8004 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
8005 {
8006 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
8007 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
8008 return true;
8009
8010 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
8011 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
8012 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
8013 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
8014 already been worked out. */
8015 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
8016 {
8017 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
8018 return false;
8019 }
8020
8021 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
8022 }
8023
8024 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
8025 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
8026 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
8027 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
8028 swap_out_syms function. */
8029
8030 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
8031 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
8032 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
8033 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
8034 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
8035
8036 bool
8037 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
8038 asymbol *isymarg,
8039 bfd *obfd,
8040 asymbol *osymarg)
8041 {
8042 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
8043
8044 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
8045 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
8046 return true;
8047
8048 isym = elf_symbol_from (isymarg);
8049 osym = elf_symbol_from (osymarg);
8050
8051 if (isym != NULL
8052 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
8053 && osym != NULL
8054 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
8055 {
8056 unsigned int shndx;
8057
8058 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
8059 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
8060 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
8061 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
8062 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
8063 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
8064 shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
8065 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
8066 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
8067 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
8068 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
8069 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
8070 }
8071
8072 return true;
8073 }
8074
8075 /* Swap out the symbols. */
8076
8077 static bool
8078 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
8079 struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
8080 int relocatable_p,
8081 struct bfd_link_info *info)
8082 {
8083 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
8084 unsigned int symcount;
8085 asymbol **syms;
8086 struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
8087 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8088 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
8089 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
8090 struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
8091 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
8092 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
8093 unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
8094 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
8095 unsigned int idx;
8096 unsigned int num_locals;
8097 size_t amt;
8098 bool name_local_sections;
8099
8100 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
8101 return false;
8102
8103 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
8104 stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
8105 if (stt == NULL)
8106 return false;
8107
8108 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8109 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
8110 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8111 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
8112 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
8113 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
8114 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
8115 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
8116
8117 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
8118 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8119
8120 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
8121 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount + 1, sizeof (*symstrtab), &amt)
8122 || (symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc (amt)) == NULL)
8123 {
8124 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
8125 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
8126 return false;
8127 }
8128
8129 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount + 1, bed->s->sizeof_sym, &amt)
8130 || (outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt)) == NULL)
8131 {
8132 error_no_mem:
8133 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
8134 error_return:
8135 free (symstrtab);
8136 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
8137 return false;
8138 }
8139 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
8140 outbound_syms_index = 0;
8141
8142 outbound_shndx = NULL;
8143 outbound_shndx_index = 0;
8144
8145 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
8146 {
8147 symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
8148 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
8149 {
8150 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount + 1,
8151 sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx), &amt))
8152 goto error_no_mem;
8153 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8154 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
8155 goto error_return;
8156
8157 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
8158 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
8159 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
8160 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
8161 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
8162 }
8163 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
8164 }
8165
8166 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
8167 {
8168 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
8169 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
8170 sym.st_name = 0;
8171 sym.st_value = 0;
8172 sym.st_size = 0;
8173 sym.st_info = 0;
8174 sym.st_other = 0;
8175 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8176 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8177 symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
8178 symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8179 symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8180 outbound_syms_index++;
8181 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8182 outbound_shndx_index++;
8183 }
8184
8185 name_local_sections
8186 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
8187 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
8188
8189 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
8190 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
8191 {
8192 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
8193 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
8194 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
8195 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
8196 int type;
8197
8198 if (!name_local_sections
8199 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8200 {
8201 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
8202 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
8203 }
8204 else
8205 {
8206 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
8207 to get the final offset for st_name. */
8208 sym.st_name
8209 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
8210 false);
8211 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8212 goto error_return;
8213 }
8214
8215 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (syms[idx]);
8216
8217 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
8218 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8219 {
8220 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
8221 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
8222 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
8223 sym.st_size = value;
8224 if (type_ptr == NULL
8225 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
8226 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
8227 else
8228 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
8229 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
8230 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
8231 }
8232 else
8233 {
8234 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
8235 unsigned int shndx;
8236
8237 if (sec->output_section)
8238 {
8239 value += sec->output_offset;
8240 sec = sec->output_section;
8241 }
8242
8243 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
8244 if (! relocatable_p)
8245 value += sec->vma;
8246 sym.st_value = value;
8247 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
8248
8249 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
8250 && type_ptr != NULL
8251 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
8252 {
8253 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
8254 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
8255 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
8256 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
8257 switch (shndx)
8258 {
8259 case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
8260 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
8261 break;
8262 case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
8263 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
8264 break;
8265 case MAP_STRTAB:
8266 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
8267 break;
8268 case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
8269 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
8270 break;
8271 case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
8272 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
8273 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
8274 break;
8275 case SHN_COMMON:
8276 case SHN_ABS:
8277 shndx = SHN_ABS;
8278 break;
8279 default:
8280 if (shndx >= SHN_LOPROC && shndx <= SHN_HIOS)
8281 {
8282 if (bed->symbol_section_index)
8283 shndx = bed->symbol_section_index (abfd, type_ptr);
8284 /* Otherwise just leave the index alone. */
8285 }
8286 else
8287 {
8288 if (shndx > SHN_HIOS && shndx < SHN_HIRESERVE)
8289 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: \
8290 Unable to handle section index %x in ELF symbol. Using ABS instead."),
8291 abfd, shndx);
8292 shndx = SHN_ABS;
8293 }
8294 break;
8295 }
8296 }
8297 else
8298 {
8299 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
8300
8301 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
8302 {
8303 asection *sec2;
8304
8305 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
8306 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
8307 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
8308 demand of applications. For example, it
8309 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
8310 section of a symbol to be a section that is
8311 actually in the output file. */
8312 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
8313 if (sec2 != NULL)
8314 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
8315 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
8316 {
8317 /* xgettext:c-format */
8318 _bfd_error_handler
8319 (_("unable to find equivalent output section"
8320 " for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
8321 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
8322 sec->name);
8323 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8324 goto error_return;
8325 }
8326 }
8327 }
8328
8329 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
8330 }
8331
8332 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8333 type = STT_TLS;
8334 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
8335 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
8336 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
8337 type = STT_FUNC;
8338 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
8339 type = STT_OBJECT;
8340 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
8341 type = STT_RELC;
8342 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
8343 type = STT_SRELC;
8344 else
8345 type = STT_NOTYPE;
8346
8347 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
8348 type = STT_TLS;
8349
8350 /* Processor-specific types. */
8351 if (type_ptr != NULL
8352 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8353 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8354 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
8355
8356 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8357 {
8358 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8359 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8360 else
8361 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
8362 }
8363 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8364 {
8365 if (type != STT_TLS)
8366 {
8367 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
8368 type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
8369 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8370 else
8371 type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
8372 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8373 }
8374 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
8375 }
8376 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
8377 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
8378 ? STB_WEAK
8379 : STB_GLOBAL),
8380 type);
8381 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
8382 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
8383 else
8384 {
8385 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
8386
8387 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
8388 bind = STB_LOCAL;
8389 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
8390 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
8391 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
8392 bind = STB_WEAK;
8393 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8394 bind = STB_GLOBAL;
8395
8396 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
8397 }
8398
8399 if (type_ptr != NULL)
8400 {
8401 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
8402 sym.st_target_internal
8403 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
8404 }
8405 else
8406 {
8407 sym.st_other = 0;
8408 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8409 }
8410
8411 idx++;
8412 symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
8413 symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8414 symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8415
8416 outbound_syms_index++;
8417 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8418 outbound_shndx_index++;
8419 }
8420
8421 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
8422 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
8423
8424 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
8425 for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
8426 {
8427 struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
8428 if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8429 elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
8430 else
8431 elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
8432 elfsym->sym.st_name);
8433 if (info && info->callbacks->ctf_new_symbol)
8434 info->callbacks->ctf_new_symbol (elfsym->dest_index,
8435 &elfsym->sym);
8436
8437 /* Inform the linker of the addition of this symbol. */
8438
8439 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
8440 (outbound_syms
8441 + (elfsym->dest_index
8442 * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
8443 (outbound_shndx
8444 + (elfsym->destshndx_index
8445 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
8446 }
8447 free (symstrtab);
8448
8449 *sttp = stt;
8450 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
8451 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8452 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
8453 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
8454 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
8455 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
8456 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
8457 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
8458
8459 return true;
8460 }
8461
8462 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8463
8464 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8465 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8466 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8467
8468 long
8469 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8470 {
8471 bfd_size_type symcount;
8472 long symtab_size;
8473 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8474
8475 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8476 if (symcount > LONG_MAX / sizeof (asymbol *))
8477 {
8478 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8479 return -1;
8480 }
8481 symtab_size = symcount * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8482 if (symcount == 0)
8483 symtab_size = sizeof (asymbol *);
8484 else if (!bfd_write_p (abfd))
8485 {
8486 ufile_ptr filesize = bfd_get_file_size (abfd);
8487
8488 if (filesize != 0 && (unsigned long) symtab_size > filesize)
8489 {
8490 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8491 return -1;
8492 }
8493 }
8494
8495 return symtab_size;
8496 }
8497
8498 long
8499 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8500 {
8501 bfd_size_type symcount;
8502 long symtab_size;
8503 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
8504
8505 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8506 {
8507 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8508 return -1;
8509 }
8510
8511 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8512 if (symcount > LONG_MAX / sizeof (asymbol *))
8513 {
8514 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8515 return -1;
8516 }
8517 symtab_size = symcount * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8518 if (symcount == 0)
8519 symtab_size = sizeof (asymbol *);
8520 else if (!bfd_write_p (abfd))
8521 {
8522 ufile_ptr filesize = bfd_get_file_size (abfd);
8523
8524 if (filesize != 0 && (unsigned long) symtab_size > filesize)
8525 {
8526 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8527 return -1;
8528 }
8529 }
8530
8531 return symtab_size;
8532 }
8533
8534 long
8535 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr asect)
8536 {
8537 if (asect->reloc_count != 0 && !bfd_write_p (abfd))
8538 {
8539 /* Sanity check reloc section size. */
8540 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d = elf_section_data (asect);
8541 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr = &d->this_hdr;
8542 bfd_size_type ext_rel_size = rel_hdr->sh_size;
8543 ufile_ptr filesize = bfd_get_file_size (abfd);
8544
8545 if (filesize != 0 && ext_rel_size > filesize)
8546 {
8547 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8548 return -1;
8549 }
8550 }
8551
8552 #if SIZEOF_LONG == SIZEOF_INT
8553 if (asect->reloc_count >= LONG_MAX / sizeof (arelent *))
8554 {
8555 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8556 return -1;
8557 }
8558 #endif
8559 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
8560 }
8561
8562 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8563
8564 long
8565 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8566 sec_ptr section,
8567 arelent **relptr,
8568 asymbol **symbols)
8569 {
8570 arelent *tblptr;
8571 unsigned int i;
8572 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8573
8574 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, false))
8575 return -1;
8576
8577 tblptr = section->relocation;
8578 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
8579 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
8580
8581 *relptr = NULL;
8582
8583 return section->reloc_count;
8584 }
8585
8586 long
8587 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
8588 {
8589 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8590 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, false);
8591
8592 if (symcount >= 0)
8593 abfd->symcount = symcount;
8594 return symcount;
8595 }
8596
8597 long
8598 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8599 asymbol **allocation)
8600 {
8601 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8602 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, true);
8603
8604 if (symcount >= 0)
8605 abfd->dynsymcount = symcount;
8606 return symcount;
8607 }
8608
8609 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8610 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8611 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8612 dynamic reloc section. */
8613
8614 long
8615 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8616 {
8617 bfd_size_type count, ext_rel_size;
8618 asection *s;
8619
8620 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8621 {
8622 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8623 return -1;
8624 }
8625
8626 count = 1;
8627 ext_rel_size = 0;
8628 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8629 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8630 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8631 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8632 {
8633 ext_rel_size += s->size;
8634 if (ext_rel_size < s->size)
8635 {
8636 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8637 return -1;
8638 }
8639 count += s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8640 if (count > LONG_MAX / sizeof (arelent *))
8641 {
8642 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8643 return -1;
8644 }
8645 }
8646 if (count > 1 && !bfd_write_p (abfd))
8647 {
8648 /* Sanity check reloc section sizes. */
8649 ufile_ptr filesize = bfd_get_file_size (abfd);
8650 if (filesize != 0 && ext_rel_size > filesize)
8651 {
8652 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8653 return -1;
8654 }
8655 }
8656 return count * sizeof (arelent *);
8657 }
8658
8659 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8660 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8661 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8662 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8663 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8664 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8665 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8666
8667 long
8668 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8669 arelent **storage,
8670 asymbol **syms)
8671 {
8672 bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool);
8673 asection *s;
8674 long ret;
8675
8676 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8677 {
8678 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8679 return -1;
8680 }
8681
8682 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8683 ret = 0;
8684 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8685 {
8686 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8687 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8688 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8689 {
8690 arelent *p;
8691 long count, i;
8692
8693 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, true))
8694 return -1;
8695 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8696 p = s->relocation;
8697 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
8698 *storage++ = p++;
8699 ret += count;
8700 }
8701 }
8702
8703 *storage = NULL;
8704
8705 return ret;
8706 }
8707 \f
8708 /* Read in the version information. */
8709
8710 bool
8711 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bool default_imported_symver)
8712 {
8713 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8714 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
8715 size_t amt;
8716
8717 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
8718 {
8719 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8720 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
8721 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
8722 unsigned int i;
8723 bfd_byte *contents_end;
8724
8725 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
8726
8727 if (hdr->sh_info == 0
8728 || hdr->sh_info > hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
8729 {
8730 error_return_bad_verref:
8731 _bfd_error_handler
8732 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
8733 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8734 error_return_verref:
8735 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
8736 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
8737 goto error_return;
8738 }
8739
8740 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
8741 goto error_return_verref;
8742 contents = _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd, hdr->sh_size, hdr->sh_size);
8743 if (contents == NULL)
8744 goto error_return_verref;
8745
8746 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed), &amt))
8747 {
8748 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8749 goto error_return_verref;
8750 }
8751 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8752 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
8753 goto error_return_verref;
8754
8755 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
8756 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
8757 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
8758 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
8759 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
8760 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
8761 {
8762 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
8763 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
8764 unsigned int j;
8765
8766 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
8767
8768 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
8769
8770 iverneed->vn_filename =
8771 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8772 iverneed->vn_file);
8773 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
8774 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8775
8776 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
8777 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
8778 else
8779 {
8780 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (iverneed->vn_cnt,
8781 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux), &amt))
8782 {
8783 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8784 goto error_return_verref;
8785 }
8786 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
8787 bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8788 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
8789 goto error_return_verref;
8790 }
8791
8792 if (iverneed->vn_aux
8793 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8794 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8795
8796 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8797 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
8798 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
8799 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
8800 {
8801 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
8802
8803 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
8804 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8805 ivernaux->vna_name);
8806 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
8807 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8808
8809 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
8810 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
8811
8812 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
8813 if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
8814 {
8815 iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
8816 break;
8817 }
8818 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
8819 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
8820
8821 if (ivernaux->vna_next
8822 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
8823 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8824
8825 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8826 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
8827 }
8828
8829 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
8830 if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
8831 break;
8832 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
8833 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
8834
8835 if (iverneed->vn_next
8836 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8837 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8838
8839 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
8840 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
8841 }
8842 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
8843
8844 free (contents);
8845 contents = NULL;
8846 }
8847
8848 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
8849 {
8850 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8851 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
8852 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8853 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
8854 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
8855 unsigned int i;
8856 unsigned int maxidx;
8857 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
8858
8859 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
8860
8861 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
8862 {
8863 error_return_bad_verdef:
8864 _bfd_error_handler
8865 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
8866 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8867 error_return_verdef:
8868 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
8869 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
8870 goto error_return;
8871 }
8872
8873 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
8874 goto error_return_verdef;
8875 contents = _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd, hdr->sh_size, hdr->sh_size);
8876 if (contents == NULL)
8877 goto error_return_verdef;
8878
8879 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
8880 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
8881 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
8882 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
8883 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
8884 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
8885
8886 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8887 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8888 the maximum. */
8889 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8890 maxidx = 0;
8891 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
8892 {
8893 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8894
8895 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
8896 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8897 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
8898 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
8899
8900 if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
8901 break;
8902
8903 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
8904 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8905 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8906
8907 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8908 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
8909 }
8910
8911 if (default_imported_symver)
8912 {
8913 if (freeidx > maxidx)
8914 maxidx = ++freeidx;
8915 else
8916 freeidx = ++maxidx;
8917 }
8918 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef), &amt))
8919 {
8920 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8921 goto error_return_verdef;
8922 }
8923 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8924 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8925 goto error_return_verdef;
8926
8927 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
8928
8929 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8930 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
8931 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
8932 {
8933 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
8934 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8935 unsigned int j;
8936
8937 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8938
8939 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
8940 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8941
8942 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
8943 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
8944
8945 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8946
8947 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
8948 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
8949 else
8950 {
8951 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (iverdef->vd_cnt,
8952 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux), &amt))
8953 {
8954 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8955 goto error_return_verdef;
8956 }
8957 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8958 bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8959 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8960 goto error_return_verdef;
8961 }
8962
8963 if (iverdef->vd_aux
8964 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8965 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8966
8967 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8968 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
8969 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8970 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
8971 {
8972 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
8973
8974 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
8975 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8976 iverdaux->vda_name);
8977 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
8978 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8979
8980 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
8981 if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
8982 {
8983 iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
8984 break;
8985 }
8986 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
8987 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
8988
8989 if (iverdaux->vda_next
8990 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8991 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8992
8993 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8994 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8995 }
8996
8997 iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8998 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
8999 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
9000
9001 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
9002 if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
9003 break;
9004 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
9005 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
9006
9007 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
9008 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
9009 }
9010
9011 free (contents);
9012 contents = NULL;
9013 }
9014 else if (default_imported_symver)
9015 {
9016 if (freeidx < 3)
9017 freeidx = 3;
9018 else
9019 freeidx++;
9020
9021 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef), &amt))
9022 {
9023 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
9024 goto error_return;
9025 }
9026 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9027 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
9028 goto error_return;
9029
9030 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
9031 }
9032
9033 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
9034 if (default_imported_symver)
9035 {
9036 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
9037 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
9038
9039 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
9040
9041 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
9042 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
9043 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
9044 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
9045
9046 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
9047
9048 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
9049 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
9050 goto error_return_verdef;
9051 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
9052 iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
9053 bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
9054 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
9055 goto error_return_verdef;
9056
9057 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
9058 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
9059 }
9060
9061 return true;
9062
9063 error_return:
9064 free (contents);
9065 return false;
9066 }
9067 \f
9068 asymbol *
9069 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
9070 {
9071 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
9072
9073 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*newsym));
9074 if (!newsym)
9075 return NULL;
9076 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
9077 return &newsym->symbol;
9078 }
9079
9080 void
9081 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9082 asymbol *symbol,
9083 symbol_info *ret)
9084 {
9085 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
9086 }
9087
9088 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
9089 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
9090 override it. */
9091
9092 bool
9093 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9094 const char *name)
9095 {
9096 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
9097 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
9098 return true;
9099
9100 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
9101 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
9102 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
9103 return true;
9104
9105 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
9106 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
9107 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
9108 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
9109 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
9110 we treat such symbols as local. */
9111 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
9112 return true;
9113
9114 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
9115 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
9116 These labels have the form:
9117
9118 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
9119
9120 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
9121
9122 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
9123 so we only need to match the rest. */
9124 if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
9125 {
9126 bool ret = false;
9127 const char * p;
9128 char c;
9129
9130 for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
9131 {
9132 if (c == 1 || c == 2)
9133 {
9134 if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
9135 /* A fake symbol. */
9136 return true;
9137
9138 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
9139 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
9140 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
9141 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
9142 other than some kind of local ? */
9143 ret = true;
9144 }
9145
9146 if (! ISDIGIT (c))
9147 {
9148 ret = false;
9149 break;
9150 }
9151 }
9152 return ret;
9153 }
9154
9155 return false;
9156 }
9157
9158 alent *
9159 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9160 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9161 {
9162 abort ();
9163 return NULL;
9164 }
9165
9166 bool
9167 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
9168 enum bfd_architecture arch,
9169 unsigned long machine)
9170 {
9171 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
9172 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
9173 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
9174 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
9175 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
9176 return false;
9177
9178 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
9179 }
9180
9181 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
9182 for error reporting. */
9183
9184 bool
9185 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
9186 asymbol **symbols,
9187 asection *section,
9188 bfd_vma offset,
9189 const char **filename_ptr,
9190 const char **functionname_ptr,
9191 unsigned int *line_ptr,
9192 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
9193 {
9194 bool found;
9195
9196 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
9197 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9198 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
9199 dwarf_debug_sections,
9200 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
9201 return true;
9202
9203 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9204 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr, line_ptr))
9205 {
9206 if (!*functionname_ptr)
9207 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9208 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
9209 functionname_ptr);
9210 return true;
9211 }
9212
9213 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9214 &found, filename_ptr,
9215 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
9216 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
9217 return false;
9218 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
9219 return true;
9220
9221 if (symbols == NULL)
9222 return false;
9223
9224 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9225 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
9226 return false;
9227
9228 *line_ptr = 0;
9229 return true;
9230 }
9231
9232 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
9233
9234 bool
9235 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
9236 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
9237 {
9238 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
9239 filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
9240 dwarf_debug_sections,
9241 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9242 }
9243
9244 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
9245 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
9246 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
9247 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
9248 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
9249
9250 bool
9251 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
9252 const char **filename_ptr,
9253 const char **functionname_ptr,
9254 unsigned int *line_ptr)
9255 {
9256 bool found;
9257 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
9258 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
9259 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9260 return found;
9261 }
9262
9263 int
9264 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
9265 {
9266 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9267 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
9268
9269 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
9270 {
9271 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
9272
9273 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
9274 {
9275 struct elf_segment_map *m;
9276
9277 phdr_size = 0;
9278 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
9279 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
9280
9281 if (phdr_size == 0)
9282 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
9283 }
9284
9285 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
9286 ret += phdr_size;
9287 }
9288
9289 return ret;
9290 }
9291
9292 bool
9293 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
9294 sec_ptr section,
9295 const void *location,
9296 file_ptr offset,
9297 bfd_size_type count)
9298 {
9299 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
9300 file_ptr pos;
9301
9302 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
9303 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
9304 return false;
9305
9306 if (!count)
9307 return true;
9308
9309 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
9310 if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
9311 {
9312 unsigned char *contents;
9313
9314 if (bfd_section_is_ctf (section))
9315 /* Nothing to do with this section: the contents are generated
9316 later. */
9317 return true;
9318
9319 if ((section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0)
9320 {
9321 _bfd_error_handler
9322 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write into an unallocated compressed section"),
9323 abfd, section);
9324 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
9325 return false;
9326 }
9327
9328 if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size)
9329 {
9330 _bfd_error_handler
9331 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write over the end of the section"),
9332 abfd, section);
9333
9334 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
9335 return false;
9336 }
9337
9338 contents = hdr->contents;
9339 if (contents == NULL)
9340 {
9341 _bfd_error_handler
9342 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write section into an empty buffer"),
9343 abfd, section);
9344
9345 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
9346 return false;
9347 }
9348
9349 memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
9350 return true;
9351 }
9352
9353 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
9354 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
9355 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
9356 return false;
9357
9358 return true;
9359 }
9360
9361 bool
9362 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9363 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9364 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9365 {
9366 abort ();
9367 return false;
9368 }
9369
9370 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
9371
9372 bool
9373 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
9374 {
9375 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
9376
9377 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
9378 {
9379 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
9380 reloc_howto_type *howto;
9381
9382 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
9383 equivalent ELF reloc. */
9384
9385 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
9386 {
9387 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
9388 {
9389 case 8:
9390 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
9391 break;
9392 case 12:
9393 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
9394 break;
9395 case 16:
9396 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
9397 break;
9398 case 24:
9399 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
9400 break;
9401 case 32:
9402 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
9403 break;
9404 case 64:
9405 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
9406 break;
9407 default:
9408 goto fail;
9409 }
9410
9411 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
9412
9413 if (howto && areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
9414 {
9415 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
9416 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
9417 else
9418 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
9419 }
9420 }
9421 else
9422 {
9423 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
9424 {
9425 case 8:
9426 code = BFD_RELOC_8;
9427 break;
9428 case 14:
9429 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
9430 break;
9431 case 16:
9432 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
9433 break;
9434 case 26:
9435 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
9436 break;
9437 case 32:
9438 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
9439 break;
9440 case 64:
9441 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
9442 break;
9443 default:
9444 goto fail;
9445 }
9446
9447 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
9448 }
9449
9450 if (howto)
9451 areloc->howto = howto;
9452 else
9453 goto fail;
9454 }
9455
9456 return true;
9457
9458 fail:
9459 /* xgettext:c-format */
9460 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
9461 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
9462 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry);
9463 return false;
9464 }
9465
9466 bool
9467 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
9468 {
9469 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
9470 if (tdata != NULL
9471 && (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object
9472 || bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
9473 {
9474 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
9475 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
9476 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9477 }
9478
9479 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
9480 }
9481
9482 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
9483 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
9484 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
9485 this reloc. */
9486
9487 bfd_reloc_status_type
9488 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
9489 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9490 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9491 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9492 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9493 {
9494 return bfd_reloc_ok;
9495 }
9496 \f
9497 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
9498 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
9499 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
9500 out details about the corefile. */
9501
9502 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
9503 # include <sys/procfs.h>
9504 #endif
9505
9506 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
9507 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
9508
9509 static int
9510 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
9511 {
9512 int pid;
9513
9514 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
9515 if (pid == 0)
9516 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
9517
9518 return pid;
9519 }
9520
9521 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
9522 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
9523 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
9524 overwrite it. */
9525
9526 static bool
9527 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
9528 {
9529 asection *sect2;
9530
9531 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
9532 return true;
9533
9534 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
9535 if (sect2 == NULL)
9536 return false;
9537
9538 sect2->size = sect->size;
9539 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
9540 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
9541 return true;
9542 }
9543
9544 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
9545 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
9546 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
9547 such a section already exists.
9548 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
9549 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
9550 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
9551 bool
9552 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9553 char *name,
9554 size_t size,
9555 ufile_ptr filepos)
9556 {
9557 char buf[100];
9558 char *threaded_name;
9559 size_t len;
9560 asection *sect;
9561
9562 /* Build the section name. */
9563
9564 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9565 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9566 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9567 if (threaded_name == NULL)
9568 return false;
9569 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
9570
9571 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
9572 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9573 if (sect == NULL)
9574 return false;
9575 sect->size = size;
9576 sect->filepos = filepos;
9577 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9578
9579 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
9580 }
9581
9582 static bool
9583 elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note,
9584 size_t offs)
9585 {
9586 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9587 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9588
9589 if (sect == NULL)
9590 return false;
9591
9592 sect->size = note->descsz - offs;
9593 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offs;
9594 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9595
9596 return true;
9597 }
9598
9599 /* prstatus_t exists on:
9600 solaris 2.5+
9601 linux 2.[01] + glibc
9602 unixware 4.2
9603 */
9604
9605 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9606
9607 static bool
9608 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9609 {
9610 size_t size;
9611 int offset;
9612
9613 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
9614 {
9615 prstatus_t prstat;
9616
9617 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9618 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
9619 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9620
9621 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9622 has already been set by another thread. */
9623 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9624 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9625 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9626 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9627
9628 /* pr_who exists on:
9629 solaris 2.5+
9630 unixware 4.2
9631 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9632 linux 2.[01]
9633 */
9634 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9635 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9636 #else
9637 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9638 #endif
9639 }
9640 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9641 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
9642 {
9643 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9644 prstatus32_t prstat;
9645
9646 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9647 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
9648 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9649
9650 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9651 has already been set by another thread. */
9652 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9653 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9654 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9655 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9656
9657 /* pr_who exists on:
9658 solaris 2.5+
9659 unixware 4.2
9660 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9661 linux 2.[01]
9662 */
9663 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9664 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9665 #else
9666 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9667 #endif
9668 }
9669 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9670 else
9671 {
9672 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9673 note size (ie. data object type). */
9674 return true;
9675 }
9676
9677 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9678 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9679 size, note->descpos + offset);
9680 }
9681 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9682
9683 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9684 static bool
9685 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9686 char *name,
9687 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9688 {
9689 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
9690 note->descsz, note->descpos);
9691 }
9692
9693 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9694 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9695 data structure apart. */
9696
9697 static bool
9698 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9699 {
9700 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9701 }
9702
9703 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9704 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9705 literally. */
9706
9707 static bool
9708 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9709 {
9710 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9711 }
9712
9713 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9714 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9715 contents literally. */
9716
9717 static bool
9718 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9719 {
9720 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
9721 }
9722
9723 static bool
9724 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9725 {
9726 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
9727 }
9728
9729 static bool
9730 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9731 {
9732 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
9733 }
9734
9735 static bool
9736 elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9737 {
9738 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tar", note);
9739 }
9740
9741 static bool
9742 elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9743 {
9744 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ppr", note);
9745 }
9746
9747 static bool
9748 elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9749 {
9750 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-dscr", note);
9751 }
9752
9753 static bool
9754 elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9755 {
9756 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ebb", note);
9757 }
9758
9759 static bool
9760 elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9761 {
9762 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-pmu", note);
9763 }
9764
9765 static bool
9766 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9767 {
9768 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr", note);
9769 }
9770
9771 static bool
9772 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9773 {
9774 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr", note);
9775 }
9776
9777 static bool
9778 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9779 {
9780 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx", note);
9781 }
9782
9783 static bool
9784 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9785 {
9786 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx", note);
9787 }
9788
9789 static bool
9790 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9791 {
9792 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr", note);
9793 }
9794
9795 static bool
9796 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9797 {
9798 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar", note);
9799 }
9800
9801 static bool
9802 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9803 {
9804 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr", note);
9805 }
9806
9807 static bool
9808 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9809 {
9810 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr", note);
9811 }
9812
9813 static bool
9814 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9815 {
9816 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
9817 }
9818
9819 static bool
9820 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9821 {
9822 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
9823 }
9824
9825 static bool
9826 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9827 {
9828 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
9829 }
9830
9831 static bool
9832 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9833 {
9834 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
9835 }
9836
9837 static bool
9838 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9839 {
9840 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
9841 }
9842
9843 static bool
9844 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9845 {
9846 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
9847 }
9848
9849 static bool
9850 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9851 {
9852 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
9853 }
9854
9855 static bool
9856 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9857 {
9858 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
9859 }
9860
9861 static bool
9862 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9863 {
9864 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
9865 }
9866
9867 static bool
9868 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9869 {
9870 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
9871 }
9872
9873 static bool
9874 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9875 {
9876 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
9877 }
9878
9879 static bool
9880 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9881 {
9882 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note);
9883 }
9884
9885 static bool
9886 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9887 {
9888 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note);
9889 }
9890
9891 static bool
9892 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9893 {
9894 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
9895 }
9896
9897 static bool
9898 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9899 {
9900 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
9901 }
9902
9903 static bool
9904 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9905 {
9906 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
9907 }
9908
9909 static bool
9910 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9911 {
9912 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
9913 }
9914
9915 static bool
9916 elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9917 {
9918 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-sve", note);
9919 }
9920
9921 static bool
9922 elfcore_grok_aarch_pauth (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9923 {
9924 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-pauth", note);
9925 }
9926
9927 static bool
9928 elfcore_grok_arc_v2 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9929 {
9930 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arc-v2", note);
9931 }
9932
9933 /* Convert NOTE into a bfd_section called ".reg-riscv-csr". Return TRUE if
9934 successful otherwise, return FALSE. */
9935
9936 static bool
9937 elfcore_grok_riscv_csr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9938 {
9939 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-riscv-csr", note);
9940 }
9941
9942 /* Convert NOTE into a bfd_section called ".gdb-tdesc". Return TRUE if
9943 successful otherwise, return FALSE. */
9944
9945 static bool
9946 elfcore_grok_gdb_tdesc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9947 {
9948 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".gdb-tdesc", note);
9949 }
9950
9951 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9952 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9953 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9954 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9955 #endif
9956 #endif
9957
9958 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9959 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9960 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9961 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9962 #endif
9963 #endif
9964
9965 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9966 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9967 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9968
9969 char *
9970 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
9971 {
9972 char *dups;
9973 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
9974 size_t len;
9975
9976 if (end == NULL)
9977 len = max;
9978 else
9979 len = end - start;
9980
9981 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
9982 if (dups == NULL)
9983 return NULL;
9984
9985 memcpy (dups, start, len);
9986 dups[len] = '\0';
9987
9988 return dups;
9989 }
9990
9991 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9992 static bool
9993 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9994 {
9995 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
9996 {
9997 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
9998
9999 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
10000
10001 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
10002 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
10003 #endif
10004 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
10005 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
10006 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
10007
10008 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10009 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
10010 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
10011 }
10012 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10013 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
10014 {
10015 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
10016 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
10017
10018 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
10019
10020 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
10021 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
10022 #endif
10023 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
10024 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
10025 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
10026
10027 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10028 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
10029 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
10030 }
10031 #endif
10032
10033 else
10034 {
10035 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
10036 note size (ie. data object type). */
10037 return true;
10038 }
10039
10040 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
10041 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
10042 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
10043
10044 {
10045 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
10046 int n = strlen (command);
10047
10048 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
10049 command[n - 1] = '\0';
10050 }
10051
10052 return true;
10053 }
10054 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
10055
10056 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10057 static bool
10058 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10059 {
10060 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
10061 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
10062 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
10063 #endif
10064 )
10065 {
10066 pstatus_t pstat;
10067
10068 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
10069
10070 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
10071 }
10072 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
10073 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
10074 {
10075 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
10076 pstatus32_t pstat;
10077
10078 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
10079
10080 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
10081 }
10082 #endif
10083 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
10084 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
10085 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
10086
10087 return true;
10088 }
10089 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
10090
10091 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10092 static bool
10093 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10094 {
10095 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
10096 char buf[100];
10097 char *name;
10098 size_t len;
10099 asection *sect;
10100
10101 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
10102 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
10103 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
10104 #endif
10105 )
10106 return true;
10107
10108 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
10109
10110 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
10111 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
10112 another thread. */
10113 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10114 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
10115
10116 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
10117
10118 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
10119 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10120 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10121 if (name == NULL)
10122 return false;
10123 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10124
10125 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10126 if (sect == NULL)
10127 return false;
10128
10129 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10130 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
10131 sect->filepos = note->descpos
10132 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
10133 #endif
10134
10135 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10136 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
10137 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
10138 #endif
10139
10140 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10141
10142 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
10143 return false;
10144
10145 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
10146
10147 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
10148 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10149 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10150 if (name == NULL)
10151 return false;
10152 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10153
10154 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10155 if (sect == NULL)
10156 return false;
10157
10158 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10159 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
10160 sect->filepos = note->descpos
10161 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
10162 #endif
10163
10164 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
10165 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
10166 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
10167 #endif
10168
10169 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10170
10171 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
10172 }
10173 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
10174
10175 /* These constants, and the structure offsets used below, are defined by
10176 Cygwin's core_dump.h */
10177 #define NOTE_INFO_PROCESS 1
10178 #define NOTE_INFO_THREAD 2
10179 #define NOTE_INFO_MODULE 3
10180 #define NOTE_INFO_MODULE64 4
10181
10182 static bool
10183 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10184 {
10185 char buf[30];
10186 char *name;
10187 size_t len;
10188 unsigned int name_size;
10189 asection *sect;
10190 unsigned int type;
10191 int is_active_thread;
10192 bfd_vma base_addr;
10193
10194 if (note->descsz < 4)
10195 return true;
10196
10197 if (! startswith (note->namedata, "win32"))
10198 return true;
10199
10200 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
10201
10202 struct
10203 {
10204 const char *type_name;
10205 unsigned long min_size;
10206 } size_check[] =
10207 {
10208 { "NOTE_INFO_PROCESS", 12 },
10209 { "NOTE_INFO_THREAD", 12 },
10210 { "NOTE_INFO_MODULE", 12 },
10211 { "NOTE_INFO_MODULE64", 16 },
10212 };
10213
10214 if (type == 0 || type > (sizeof(size_check)/sizeof(size_check[0])))
10215 return true;
10216
10217 if (note->descsz < size_check[type - 1].min_size)
10218 {
10219 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: win32pstatus %s of size %lu bytes is too small"),
10220 abfd, size_check[type - 1].type_name, note->descsz);
10221 return true;
10222 }
10223
10224 switch (type)
10225 {
10226 case NOTE_INFO_PROCESS:
10227 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
10228 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
10229 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
10230 break;
10231
10232 case NOTE_INFO_THREAD:
10233 /* Make a ".reg/<tid>" section containing the Win32 API thread CONTEXT
10234 structure. */
10235 /* thread_info.tid */
10236 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4));
10237
10238 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10239 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10240 if (name == NULL)
10241 return false;
10242
10243 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10244
10245 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10246 if (sect == NULL)
10247 return false;
10248
10249 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
10250 sect->size = note->descsz - 12;
10251 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
10252 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
10253 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10254
10255 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
10256 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
10257
10258 if (is_active_thread)
10259 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
10260 return false;
10261 break;
10262
10263 case NOTE_INFO_MODULE:
10264 case NOTE_INFO_MODULE64:
10265 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
10266 if (type == NOTE_INFO_MODULE)
10267 {
10268 /* module_info.base_address */
10269 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
10270 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
10271 /* module_info.module_name_size */
10272 name_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
10273 }
10274 else /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE64 */
10275 {
10276 /* module_info.base_address */
10277 base_addr = bfd_get_64 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
10278 sprintf (buf, ".module/%016lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
10279 /* module_info.module_name_size */
10280 name_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
10281 }
10282
10283 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10284 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10285 if (name == NULL)
10286 return false;
10287
10288 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10289
10290 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10291
10292 if (sect == NULL)
10293 return false;
10294
10295 if (note->descsz < 12 + name_size)
10296 {
10297 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: win32pstatus NOTE_INFO_MODULE of size %lu is too small to contain a name of size %u"),
10298 abfd, note->descsz, name_size);
10299 return true;
10300 }
10301
10302 sect->size = note->descsz;
10303 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10304 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10305 break;
10306
10307 default:
10308 return true;
10309 }
10310
10311 return true;
10312 }
10313
10314 static bool
10315 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10316 {
10317 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10318
10319 switch (note->type)
10320 {
10321 default:
10322 return true;
10323
10324 case NT_PRSTATUS:
10325 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
10326 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10327 return true;
10328 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10329 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
10330 #else
10331 return true;
10332 #endif
10333
10334 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10335 case NT_PSTATUS:
10336 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
10337 #endif
10338
10339 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10340 case NT_LWPSTATUS:
10341 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
10342 #endif
10343
10344 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
10345 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10346
10347 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
10348 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
10349
10350 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
10351 if (note->namesz == 6
10352 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10353 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
10354 else
10355 return true;
10356
10357 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
10358 if (note->namesz == 6
10359 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10360 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10361 else
10362 return true;
10363
10364 case NT_PPC_VMX:
10365 if (note->namesz == 6
10366 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10367 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
10368 else
10369 return true;
10370
10371 case NT_PPC_VSX:
10372 if (note->namesz == 6
10373 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10374 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
10375 else
10376 return true;
10377
10378 case NT_PPC_TAR:
10379 if (note->namesz == 6
10380 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10381 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (abfd, note);
10382 else
10383 return true;
10384
10385 case NT_PPC_PPR:
10386 if (note->namesz == 6
10387 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10388 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (abfd, note);
10389 else
10390 return true;
10391
10392 case NT_PPC_DSCR:
10393 if (note->namesz == 6
10394 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10395 return elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (abfd, note);
10396 else
10397 return true;
10398
10399 case NT_PPC_EBB:
10400 if (note->namesz == 6
10401 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10402 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (abfd, note);
10403 else
10404 return true;
10405
10406 case NT_PPC_PMU:
10407 if (note->namesz == 6
10408 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10409 return elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (abfd, note);
10410 else
10411 return true;
10412
10413 case NT_PPC_TM_CGPR:
10414 if (note->namesz == 6
10415 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10416 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, note);
10417 else
10418 return true;
10419
10420 case NT_PPC_TM_CFPR:
10421 if (note->namesz == 6
10422 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10423 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, note);
10424 else
10425 return true;
10426
10427 case NT_PPC_TM_CVMX:
10428 if (note->namesz == 6
10429 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10430 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, note);
10431 else
10432 return true;
10433
10434 case NT_PPC_TM_CVSX:
10435 if (note->namesz == 6
10436 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10437 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, note);
10438 else
10439 return true;
10440
10441 case NT_PPC_TM_SPR:
10442 if (note->namesz == 6
10443 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10444 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, note);
10445 else
10446 return true;
10447
10448 case NT_PPC_TM_CTAR:
10449 if (note->namesz == 6
10450 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10451 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, note);
10452 else
10453 return true;
10454
10455 case NT_PPC_TM_CPPR:
10456 if (note->namesz == 6
10457 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10458 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, note);
10459 else
10460 return true;
10461
10462 case NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR:
10463 if (note->namesz == 6
10464 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10465 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, note);
10466 else
10467 return true;
10468
10469 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
10470 if (note->namesz == 6
10471 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10472 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
10473 else
10474 return true;
10475
10476 case NT_S390_TIMER:
10477 if (note->namesz == 6
10478 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10479 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
10480 else
10481 return true;
10482
10483 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
10484 if (note->namesz == 6
10485 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10486 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
10487 else
10488 return true;
10489
10490 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
10491 if (note->namesz == 6
10492 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10493 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
10494 else
10495 return true;
10496
10497 case NT_S390_CTRS:
10498 if (note->namesz == 6
10499 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10500 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
10501 else
10502 return true;
10503
10504 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
10505 if (note->namesz == 6
10506 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10507 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
10508 else
10509 return true;
10510
10511 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
10512 if (note->namesz == 6
10513 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10514 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
10515 else
10516 return true;
10517
10518 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
10519 if (note->namesz == 6
10520 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10521 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
10522 else
10523 return true;
10524
10525 case NT_S390_TDB:
10526 if (note->namesz == 6
10527 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10528 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
10529 else
10530 return true;
10531
10532 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
10533 if (note->namesz == 6
10534 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10535 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
10536 else
10537 return true;
10538
10539 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
10540 if (note->namesz == 6
10541 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10542 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
10543 else
10544 return true;
10545
10546 case NT_S390_GS_CB:
10547 if (note->namesz == 6
10548 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10549 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd, note);
10550 else
10551 return true;
10552
10553 case NT_S390_GS_BC:
10554 if (note->namesz == 6
10555 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10556 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd, note);
10557 else
10558 return true;
10559
10560 case NT_ARC_V2:
10561 if (note->namesz == 6
10562 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10563 return elfcore_grok_arc_v2 (abfd, note);
10564 else
10565 return true;
10566
10567 case NT_ARM_VFP:
10568 if (note->namesz == 6
10569 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10570 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10571 else
10572 return true;
10573
10574 case NT_ARM_TLS:
10575 if (note->namesz == 6
10576 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10577 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
10578 else
10579 return true;
10580
10581 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
10582 if (note->namesz == 6
10583 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10584 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
10585 else
10586 return true;
10587
10588 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
10589 if (note->namesz == 6
10590 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10591 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
10592 else
10593 return true;
10594
10595 case NT_ARM_SVE:
10596 if (note->namesz == 6
10597 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10598 return elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (abfd, note);
10599 else
10600 return true;
10601
10602 case NT_ARM_PAC_MASK:
10603 if (note->namesz == 6
10604 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10605 return elfcore_grok_aarch_pauth (abfd, note);
10606 else
10607 return true;
10608
10609 case NT_GDB_TDESC:
10610 if (note->namesz == 4
10611 && strcmp (note->namedata, "GDB") == 0)
10612 return elfcore_grok_gdb_tdesc (abfd, note);
10613 else
10614 return true;
10615
10616 case NT_RISCV_CSR:
10617 if (note->namesz == 4
10618 && strcmp (note->namedata, "GDB") == 0)
10619 return elfcore_grok_riscv_csr (abfd, note);
10620 else
10621 return true;
10622
10623 case NT_PRPSINFO:
10624 case NT_PSINFO:
10625 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
10626 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
10627 return true;
10628 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10629 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
10630 #else
10631 return true;
10632 #endif
10633
10634 case NT_AUXV:
10635 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 0);
10636
10637 case NT_FILE:
10638 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
10639 note);
10640
10641 case NT_SIGINFO:
10642 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
10643 note);
10644
10645 }
10646 }
10647
10648 static bool
10649 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10650 {
10651 struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
10652
10653 if (note->descsz == 0)
10654 return false;
10655
10656 build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
10657 if (build_id == NULL)
10658 return false;
10659
10660 build_id->size = note->descsz;
10661 memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10662 abfd->build_id = build_id;
10663
10664 return true;
10665 }
10666
10667 static bool
10668 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10669 {
10670 switch (note->type)
10671 {
10672 default:
10673 return true;
10674
10675 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
10676 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
10677
10678 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
10679 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
10680 }
10681 }
10682
10683 static bool
10684 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10685 {
10686 struct sdt_note *cur =
10687 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
10688 sizeof (struct sdt_note) + note->descsz);
10689
10690 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
10691 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
10692 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10693
10694 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
10695
10696 return true;
10697 }
10698
10699 static bool
10700 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10701 {
10702 switch (note->type)
10703 {
10704 case NT_STAPSDT:
10705 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
10706
10707 default:
10708 return true;
10709 }
10710 }
10711
10712 static bool
10713 elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10714 {
10715 size_t offset;
10716
10717 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10718 {
10719 case ELFCLASS32:
10720 if (note->descsz < 108)
10721 return false;
10722 break;
10723
10724 case ELFCLASS64:
10725 if (note->descsz < 120)
10726 return false;
10727 break;
10728
10729 default:
10730 return false;
10731 }
10732
10733 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10734 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10735 return false;
10736
10737 offset = 4;
10738
10739 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
10740 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10741 offset += 4;
10742 else
10743 {
10744 offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
10745 offset += 8;
10746 }
10747
10748 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
10749 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
10750 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
10751 offset += 17;
10752
10753 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
10754 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10755 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
10756 offset += 81;
10757
10758 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
10759 offset += 2;
10760
10761 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
10762 if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
10763 return true;
10764
10765 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10766 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10767
10768 return true;
10769 }
10770
10771 static bool
10772 elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10773 {
10774 size_t offset;
10775 size_t size;
10776 size_t min_size;
10777
10778 /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
10779 Also compute minimum size of this note. */
10780 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10781 {
10782 case ELFCLASS32:
10783 offset = 4 + 4;
10784 min_size = offset + (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
10785 break;
10786
10787 case ELFCLASS64:
10788 offset = 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
10789 min_size = offset + (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
10790 break;
10791
10792 default:
10793 return false;
10794 }
10795
10796 if (note->descsz < min_size)
10797 return false;
10798
10799 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10800 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10801 return false;
10802
10803 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
10804 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
10805 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10806 {
10807 size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10808 offset += 4 * 2;
10809 }
10810 else
10811 {
10812 size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10813 offset += 8 * 2;
10814 }
10815
10816 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
10817 offset += 4;
10818
10819 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
10820 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10821 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10822 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10823 offset += 4;
10824
10825 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
10826 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
10827 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10828 offset += 4;
10829
10830 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
10831 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
10832 offset += 4;
10833
10834 /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
10835 if ((note->descsz - offset) < size)
10836 return false;
10837
10838 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
10839 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
10840 size, note->descpos + offset);
10841 }
10842
10843 static bool
10844 elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10845 {
10846 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10847
10848 switch (note->type)
10849 {
10850 case NT_PRSTATUS:
10851 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus)
10852 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10853 return true;
10854 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
10855
10856 case NT_FPREGSET:
10857 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10858
10859 case NT_PRPSINFO:
10860 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
10861
10862 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
10863 if (note->namesz == 8)
10864 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
10865 else
10866 return true;
10867
10868 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC:
10869 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
10870 note);
10871
10872 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES:
10873 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
10874 note);
10875
10876 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP:
10877 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
10878 note);
10879
10880 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
10881 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 4);
10882
10883 case NT_X86_XSTATE:
10884 if (note->namesz == 8)
10885 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10886 else
10887 return true;
10888
10889 case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO:
10890 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10891 note);
10892
10893 case NT_ARM_VFP:
10894 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10895
10896 default:
10897 return true;
10898 }
10899 }
10900
10901 static bool
10902 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
10903 {
10904 char *cp;
10905
10906 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
10907 if (cp != NULL)
10908 {
10909 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
10910 return true;
10911 }
10912 return false;
10913 }
10914
10915 static bool
10916 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10917 {
10918 if (note->descsz <= 0x7c + 31)
10919 return false;
10920
10921 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10922 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10923 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10924
10925 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10926 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10927 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
10928
10929 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10930 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10931 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
10932
10933 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10934 note);
10935 }
10936
10937 static bool
10938 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10939 {
10940 int lwp;
10941
10942 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
10943 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
10944
10945 switch (note->type)
10946 {
10947 case NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO:
10948 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10949 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10950 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10951 creates a core file. */
10952 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10953 case NT_NETBSDCORE_AUXV:
10954 /* NetBSD-specific Elf Auxiliary Vector data. */
10955 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 4);
10956 case NT_NETBSDCORE_LWPSTATUS:
10957 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd,
10958 ".note.netbsdcore.lwpstatus",
10959 note);
10960 default:
10961 break;
10962 }
10963
10964 /* As of March 2020 there are no other machine-independent notes
10965 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10966 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10967 understand it. */
10968
10969 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
10970 return true;
10971
10972
10973 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
10974 {
10975 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10976 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10977
10978 case bfd_arch_aarch64:
10979 case bfd_arch_alpha:
10980 case bfd_arch_sparc:
10981 switch (note->type)
10982 {
10983 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
10984 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10985
10986 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
10987 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10988
10989 default:
10990 return true;
10991 }
10992
10993 /* On SuperH, PT_GETREGS == mach+3 and PT_GETFPREGS == mach+5.
10994 There's also old PT___GETREGS40 == mach + 1 for old reg
10995 structure which lacks GBR. */
10996
10997 case bfd_arch_sh:
10998 switch (note->type)
10999 {
11000 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
11001 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
11002
11003 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+5:
11004 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
11005
11006 default:
11007 return true;
11008 }
11009
11010 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
11011 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
11012
11013 default:
11014 switch (note->type)
11015 {
11016 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
11017 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
11018
11019 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
11020 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
11021
11022 default:
11023 return true;
11024 }
11025 }
11026 /* NOTREACHED */
11027 }
11028
11029 static bool
11030 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
11031 {
11032 if (note->descsz <= 0x48 + 31)
11033 return false;
11034
11035 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
11036 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
11037 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
11038
11039 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
11040 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
11041 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
11042
11043 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
11044 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
11045 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
11046
11047 return true;
11048 }
11049
11050 static bool
11051 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
11052 {
11053 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
11054 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
11055
11056 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
11057 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
11058
11059 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
11060 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
11061
11062 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
11063 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
11064
11065 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
11066 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 0);
11067
11068 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
11069 {
11070 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
11071 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11072
11073 if (sect == NULL)
11074 return false;
11075 sect->size = note->descsz;
11076 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11077 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
11078
11079 return true;
11080 }
11081
11082 return true;
11083 }
11084
11085 static bool
11086 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
11087 {
11088 void *ddata = note->descdata;
11089 char buf[100];
11090 char *name;
11091 asection *sect;
11092 short sig;
11093 unsigned flags;
11094
11095 if (note->descsz < 16)
11096 return false;
11097
11098 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
11099 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
11100
11101 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
11102 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
11103
11104 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
11105 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
11106
11107 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
11108 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
11109 {
11110 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
11111 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
11112 }
11113
11114 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
11115 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
11116 thread just in case. */
11117 if (flags & 0x00000080)
11118 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
11119
11120 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
11121 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
11122
11123 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
11124 if (name == NULL)
11125 return false;
11126 strcpy (name, buf);
11127
11128 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11129 if (sect == NULL)
11130 return false;
11131
11132 sect->size = note->descsz;
11133 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11134 sect->alignment_power = 2;
11135
11136 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
11137 }
11138
11139 static bool
11140 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
11141 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
11142 long tid,
11143 char *base)
11144 {
11145 char buf[100];
11146 char *name;
11147 asection *sect;
11148
11149 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
11150 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
11151
11152 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
11153 if (name == NULL)
11154 return false;
11155 strcpy (name, buf);
11156
11157 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11158 if (sect == NULL)
11159 return false;
11160
11161 sect->size = note->descsz;
11162 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11163 sect->alignment_power = 2;
11164
11165 /* This is the current thread. */
11166 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
11167 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
11168
11169 return true;
11170 }
11171
11172 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
11173 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
11174 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
11175 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
11176
11177 static bool
11178 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
11179 {
11180 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
11181 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
11182 function. */
11183 static long tid = 1;
11184
11185 switch (note->type)
11186 {
11187 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
11188 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
11189 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
11190 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
11191 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
11192 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
11193 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
11194 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
11195 default:
11196 return true;
11197 }
11198 }
11199
11200 static bool
11201 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
11202 {
11203 char *name;
11204 asection *sect;
11205 size_t len;
11206
11207 /* Use note name as section name. */
11208 len = note->namesz;
11209 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
11210 if (name == NULL)
11211 return false;
11212 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
11213 name[len - 1] = '\0';
11214
11215 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11216 if (sect == NULL)
11217 return false;
11218
11219 sect->size = note->descsz;
11220 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11221 sect->alignment_power = 1;
11222
11223 return true;
11224 }
11225
11226 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
11227
11228 Inputs:
11229 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
11230 name of note
11231 type of note
11232 data for note
11233 size of data for note
11234
11235 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
11236 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
11237 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
11238 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
11239
11240 Return:
11241 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
11242
11243 char *
11244 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
11245 char *buf,
11246 int *bufsiz,
11247 const char *name,
11248 int type,
11249 const void *input,
11250 int size)
11251 {
11252 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
11253 size_t namesz;
11254 size_t newspace;
11255 char *dest;
11256
11257 namesz = 0;
11258 if (name != NULL)
11259 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
11260
11261 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
11262
11263 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
11264 if (buf == NULL)
11265 return buf;
11266 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
11267 *bufsiz += newspace;
11268 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
11269 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
11270 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
11271 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
11272 dest = xnp->name;
11273 if (name != NULL)
11274 {
11275 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
11276 dest += namesz;
11277 while (namesz & 3)
11278 {
11279 *dest++ = '\0';
11280 ++namesz;
11281 }
11282 }
11283 memcpy (dest, input, size);
11284 dest += size;
11285 while (size & 3)
11286 {
11287 *dest++ = '\0';
11288 ++size;
11289 }
11290 return buf;
11291 }
11292
11293 /* gcc-8 warns (*) on all the strncpy calls in this function about
11294 possible string truncation. The "truncation" is not a bug. We
11295 have an external representation of structs with fields that are not
11296 necessarily NULL terminated and corresponding internal
11297 representation fields that are one larger so that they can always
11298 be NULL terminated.
11299 gcc versions between 4.2 and 4.6 do not allow pragma control of
11300 diagnostics inside functions, giving a hard error if you try to use
11301 the finer control available with later versions.
11302 gcc prior to 4.2 warns about diagnostic push and pop.
11303 gcc-5, gcc-6 and gcc-7 warn that -Wstringop-truncation is unknown,
11304 unless you also add #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragma".
11305 (*) Depending on your system header files! */
11306 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
11307 # pragma GCC diagnostic push
11308 # pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstringop-truncation"
11309 #endif
11310 char *
11311 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
11312 char *buf,
11313 int *bufsiz,
11314 const char *fname,
11315 const char *psargs)
11316 {
11317 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11318
11319 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
11320 {
11321 char *ret;
11322 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11323 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
11324 if (ret != NULL)
11325 return ret;
11326 }
11327
11328 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
11329 # if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
11330 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
11331 {
11332 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
11333 psinfo32_t data;
11334 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
11335 # else
11336 prpsinfo32_t data;
11337 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
11338 # endif
11339
11340 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
11341 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
11342 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
11343 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11344 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
11345 }
11346 else
11347 # endif
11348 {
11349 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
11350 psinfo_t data;
11351 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
11352 # else
11353 prpsinfo_t data;
11354 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
11355 # endif
11356
11357 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
11358 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
11359 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
11360 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11361 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
11362 }
11363 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
11364
11365 free (buf);
11366 return NULL;
11367 }
11368 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
11369 # pragma GCC diagnostic pop
11370 #endif
11371
11372 char *
11373 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
11374 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
11375 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
11376 {
11377 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16)
11378 {
11379 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data;
11380
11381 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11382 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
11383 &data, sizeof (data));
11384 }
11385 else
11386 {
11387 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data;
11388
11389 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11390 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
11391 &data, sizeof (data));
11392 }
11393 }
11394
11395 char *
11396 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
11397 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
11398 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
11399 {
11400 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16)
11401 {
11402 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data;
11403
11404 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11405 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11406 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
11407 }
11408 else
11409 {
11410 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data;
11411
11412 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11413 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11414 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
11415 }
11416 }
11417
11418 char *
11419 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
11420 char *buf,
11421 int *bufsiz,
11422 long pid,
11423 int cursig,
11424 const void *gregs)
11425 {
11426 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11427
11428 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
11429 {
11430 char *ret;
11431 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11432 NT_PRSTATUS,
11433 pid, cursig, gregs);
11434 if (ret != NULL)
11435 return ret;
11436 }
11437
11438 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
11439 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
11440 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
11441 {
11442 prstatus32_t prstat;
11443
11444 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
11445 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
11446 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
11447 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
11448 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
11449 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
11450 }
11451 else
11452 #endif
11453 {
11454 prstatus_t prstat;
11455
11456 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
11457 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
11458 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
11459 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
11460 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
11461 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
11462 }
11463 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
11464
11465 free (buf);
11466 return NULL;
11467 }
11468
11469 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
11470 char *
11471 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
11472 char *buf,
11473 int *bufsiz,
11474 long pid,
11475 int cursig,
11476 const void *gregs)
11477 {
11478 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
11479 const char *note_name = "CORE";
11480
11481 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
11482 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
11483 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
11484 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
11485 memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
11486 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
11487 #if !defined(gregs)
11488 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
11489 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
11490 #else
11491 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
11492 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
11493 #endif
11494 #endif
11495 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
11496 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
11497 }
11498 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
11499
11500 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
11501 char *
11502 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
11503 char *buf,
11504 int *bufsiz,
11505 long pid,
11506 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11507 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11508 {
11509 const char *note_name = "CORE";
11510 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
11511 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11512
11513 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
11514 {
11515 pstatus32_t pstat;
11516
11517 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
11518 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
11519 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
11520 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
11521 return buf;
11522 }
11523 else
11524 #endif
11525 {
11526 pstatus_t pstat;
11527
11528 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
11529 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
11530 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
11531 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
11532 return buf;
11533 }
11534 }
11535 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
11536
11537 char *
11538 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
11539 char *buf,
11540 int *bufsiz,
11541 const void *fpregs,
11542 int size)
11543 {
11544 const char *note_name = "CORE";
11545 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11546 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
11547 }
11548
11549 char *
11550 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
11551 char *buf,
11552 int *bufsiz,
11553 const void *xfpregs,
11554 int size)
11555 {
11556 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11557 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11558 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
11559 }
11560
11561 char *
11562 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
11563 const void *xfpregs, int size)
11564 {
11565 char *note_name;
11566 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
11567 note_name = "FreeBSD";
11568 else
11569 note_name = "LINUX";
11570 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11571 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
11572 }
11573
11574 char *
11575 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
11576 char *buf,
11577 int *bufsiz,
11578 const void *ppc_vmx,
11579 int size)
11580 {
11581 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11582 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11583 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
11584 }
11585
11586 char *
11587 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
11588 char *buf,
11589 int *bufsiz,
11590 const void *ppc_vsx,
11591 int size)
11592 {
11593 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11594 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11595 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
11596 }
11597
11598 char *
11599 elfcore_write_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd,
11600 char *buf,
11601 int *bufsiz,
11602 const void *ppc_tar,
11603 int size)
11604 {
11605 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11606 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11607 note_name, NT_PPC_TAR, ppc_tar, size);
11608 }
11609
11610 char *
11611 elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd,
11612 char *buf,
11613 int *bufsiz,
11614 const void *ppc_ppr,
11615 int size)
11616 {
11617 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11618 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11619 note_name, NT_PPC_PPR, ppc_ppr, size);
11620 }
11621
11622 char *
11623 elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd,
11624 char *buf,
11625 int *bufsiz,
11626 const void *ppc_dscr,
11627 int size)
11628 {
11629 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11630 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11631 note_name, NT_PPC_DSCR, ppc_dscr, size);
11632 }
11633
11634 char *
11635 elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd,
11636 char *buf,
11637 int *bufsiz,
11638 const void *ppc_ebb,
11639 int size)
11640 {
11641 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11642 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11643 note_name, NT_PPC_EBB, ppc_ebb, size);
11644 }
11645
11646 char *
11647 elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd,
11648 char *buf,
11649 int *bufsiz,
11650 const void *ppc_pmu,
11651 int size)
11652 {
11653 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11654 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11655 note_name, NT_PPC_PMU, ppc_pmu, size);
11656 }
11657
11658 char *
11659 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd,
11660 char *buf,
11661 int *bufsiz,
11662 const void *ppc_tm_cgpr,
11663 int size)
11664 {
11665 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11666 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11667 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CGPR, ppc_tm_cgpr, size);
11668 }
11669
11670 char *
11671 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd,
11672 char *buf,
11673 int *bufsiz,
11674 const void *ppc_tm_cfpr,
11675 int size)
11676 {
11677 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11678 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11679 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CFPR, ppc_tm_cfpr, size);
11680 }
11681
11682 char *
11683 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd,
11684 char *buf,
11685 int *bufsiz,
11686 const void *ppc_tm_cvmx,
11687 int size)
11688 {
11689 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11690 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11691 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVMX, ppc_tm_cvmx, size);
11692 }
11693
11694 char *
11695 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd,
11696 char *buf,
11697 int *bufsiz,
11698 const void *ppc_tm_cvsx,
11699 int size)
11700 {
11701 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11702 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11703 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVSX, ppc_tm_cvsx, size);
11704 }
11705
11706 char *
11707 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd,
11708 char *buf,
11709 int *bufsiz,
11710 const void *ppc_tm_spr,
11711 int size)
11712 {
11713 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11714 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11715 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_SPR, ppc_tm_spr, size);
11716 }
11717
11718 char *
11719 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd,
11720 char *buf,
11721 int *bufsiz,
11722 const void *ppc_tm_ctar,
11723 int size)
11724 {
11725 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11726 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11727 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CTAR, ppc_tm_ctar, size);
11728 }
11729
11730 char *
11731 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd,
11732 char *buf,
11733 int *bufsiz,
11734 const void *ppc_tm_cppr,
11735 int size)
11736 {
11737 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11738 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11739 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CPPR, ppc_tm_cppr, size);
11740 }
11741
11742 char *
11743 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd,
11744 char *buf,
11745 int *bufsiz,
11746 const void *ppc_tm_cdscr,
11747 int size)
11748 {
11749 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11750 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11751 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR, ppc_tm_cdscr, size);
11752 }
11753
11754 static char *
11755 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
11756 char *buf,
11757 int *bufsiz,
11758 const void *s390_high_gprs,
11759 int size)
11760 {
11761 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11762 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11763 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
11764 s390_high_gprs, size);
11765 }
11766
11767 char *
11768 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
11769 char *buf,
11770 int *bufsiz,
11771 const void *s390_timer,
11772 int size)
11773 {
11774 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11775 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11776 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
11777 }
11778
11779 char *
11780 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
11781 char *buf,
11782 int *bufsiz,
11783 const void *s390_todcmp,
11784 int size)
11785 {
11786 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11787 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11788 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
11789 }
11790
11791 char *
11792 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
11793 char *buf,
11794 int *bufsiz,
11795 const void *s390_todpreg,
11796 int size)
11797 {
11798 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11799 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11800 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
11801 }
11802
11803 char *
11804 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
11805 char *buf,
11806 int *bufsiz,
11807 const void *s390_ctrs,
11808 int size)
11809 {
11810 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11811 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11812 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
11813 }
11814
11815 char *
11816 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
11817 char *buf,
11818 int *bufsiz,
11819 const void *s390_prefix,
11820 int size)
11821 {
11822 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11823 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11824 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
11825 }
11826
11827 char *
11828 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
11829 char *buf,
11830 int *bufsiz,
11831 const void *s390_last_break,
11832 int size)
11833 {
11834 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11835 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11836 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
11837 s390_last_break, size);
11838 }
11839
11840 char *
11841 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
11842 char *buf,
11843 int *bufsiz,
11844 const void *s390_system_call,
11845 int size)
11846 {
11847 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11848 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11849 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
11850 s390_system_call, size);
11851 }
11852
11853 char *
11854 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
11855 char *buf,
11856 int *bufsiz,
11857 const void *s390_tdb,
11858 int size)
11859 {
11860 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11861 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11862 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
11863 }
11864
11865 char *
11866 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
11867 char *buf,
11868 int *bufsiz,
11869 const void *s390_vxrs_low,
11870 int size)
11871 {
11872 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11873 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11874 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
11875 }
11876
11877 char *
11878 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
11879 char *buf,
11880 int *bufsiz,
11881 const void *s390_vxrs_high,
11882 int size)
11883 {
11884 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11885 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11886 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
11887 s390_vxrs_high, size);
11888 }
11889
11890 char *
11891 elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd,
11892 char *buf,
11893 int *bufsiz,
11894 const void *s390_gs_cb,
11895 int size)
11896 {
11897 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11898 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11899 note_name, NT_S390_GS_CB,
11900 s390_gs_cb, size);
11901 }
11902
11903 char *
11904 elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd,
11905 char *buf,
11906 int *bufsiz,
11907 const void *s390_gs_bc,
11908 int size)
11909 {
11910 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11911 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11912 note_name, NT_S390_GS_BC,
11913 s390_gs_bc, size);
11914 }
11915
11916 char *
11917 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
11918 char *buf,
11919 int *bufsiz,
11920 const void *arm_vfp,
11921 int size)
11922 {
11923 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11924 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11925 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
11926 }
11927
11928 char *
11929 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
11930 char *buf,
11931 int *bufsiz,
11932 const void *aarch_tls,
11933 int size)
11934 {
11935 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11936 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11937 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
11938 }
11939
11940 char *
11941 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
11942 char *buf,
11943 int *bufsiz,
11944 const void *aarch_hw_break,
11945 int size)
11946 {
11947 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11948 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11949 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
11950 }
11951
11952 char *
11953 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
11954 char *buf,
11955 int *bufsiz,
11956 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
11957 int size)
11958 {
11959 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11960 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11961 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
11962 }
11963
11964 char *
11965 elfcore_write_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd,
11966 char *buf,
11967 int *bufsiz,
11968 const void *aarch_sve,
11969 int size)
11970 {
11971 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11972 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11973 note_name, NT_ARM_SVE, aarch_sve, size);
11974 }
11975
11976 char *
11977 elfcore_write_aarch_pauth (bfd *abfd,
11978 char *buf,
11979 int *bufsiz,
11980 const void *aarch_pauth,
11981 int size)
11982 {
11983 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11984 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11985 note_name, NT_ARM_PAC_MASK, aarch_pauth, size);
11986 }
11987
11988 char *
11989 elfcore_write_arc_v2 (bfd *abfd,
11990 char *buf,
11991 int *bufsiz,
11992 const void *arc_v2,
11993 int size)
11994 {
11995 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11996 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11997 note_name, NT_ARC_V2, arc_v2, size);
11998 }
11999
12000 /* Write the buffer of csr values in CSRS (length SIZE) into the note
12001 buffer BUF and update *BUFSIZ. ABFD is the bfd the note is being
12002 written into. Return a pointer to the new start of the note buffer, to
12003 replace BUF which may no longer be valid. */
12004
12005 char *
12006 elfcore_write_riscv_csr (bfd *abfd,
12007 char *buf,
12008 int *bufsiz,
12009 const void *csrs,
12010 int size)
12011 {
12012 const char *note_name = "GDB";
12013 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
12014 note_name, NT_RISCV_CSR, csrs, size);
12015 }
12016
12017 /* Write the target description (a string) pointed to by TDESC, length
12018 SIZE, into the note buffer BUF, and update *BUFSIZ. ABFD is the bfd the
12019 note is being written into. Return a pointer to the new start of the
12020 note buffer, to replace BUF which may no longer be valid. */
12021
12022 char *
12023 elfcore_write_gdb_tdesc (bfd *abfd,
12024 char *buf,
12025 int *bufsiz,
12026 const void *tdesc,
12027 int size)
12028 {
12029 const char *note_name = "GDB";
12030 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
12031 note_name, NT_GDB_TDESC, tdesc, size);
12032 }
12033
12034 char *
12035 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
12036 char *buf,
12037 int *bufsiz,
12038 const char *section,
12039 const void *data,
12040 int size)
12041 {
12042 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
12043 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12044 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
12045 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12046 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
12047 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12048 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
12049 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12050 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
12051 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12052 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tar") == 0)
12053 return elfcore_write_ppc_tar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12054 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ppr") == 0)
12055 return elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12056 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-dscr") == 0)
12057 return elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12058 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ebb") == 0)
12059 return elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12060 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-pmu") == 0)
12061 return elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12062 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr") == 0)
12063 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12064 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr") == 0)
12065 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12066 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx") == 0)
12067 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12068 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx") == 0)
12069 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12070 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr") == 0)
12071 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12072 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar") == 0)
12073 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12074 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr") == 0)
12075 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12076 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr") == 0)
12077 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12078 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
12079 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12080 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
12081 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12082 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
12083 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12084 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
12085 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12086 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
12087 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12088 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
12089 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12090 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
12091 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12092 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
12093 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12094 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
12095 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12096 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
12097 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12098 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
12099 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12100 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
12101 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12102 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
12103 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12104 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
12105 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12106 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
12107 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12108 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
12109 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12110 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
12111 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12112 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-sve") == 0)
12113 return elfcore_write_aarch_sve (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12114 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-pauth") == 0)
12115 return elfcore_write_aarch_pauth (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12116 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arc-v2") == 0)
12117 return elfcore_write_arc_v2 (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12118 if (strcmp (section, ".gdb-tdesc") == 0)
12119 return elfcore_write_gdb_tdesc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12120 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-riscv-csr") == 0)
12121 return elfcore_write_riscv_csr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12122 return NULL;
12123 }
12124
12125 char *
12126 elfcore_write_file_note (bfd *obfd, char *note_data, int *note_size,
12127 const void *buf, int bufsiz)
12128 {
12129 return elfcore_write_note (obfd, note_data, note_size,
12130 "CORE", NT_FILE, buf, bufsiz);
12131 }
12132
12133 static bool
12134 elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset,
12135 size_t align)
12136 {
12137 char *p;
12138
12139 /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
12140 gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
12141 bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects. If
12142 align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment. */
12143 if (align < 4)
12144 align = 4;
12145 if (align != 4 && align != 8)
12146 return false;
12147
12148 p = buf;
12149 while (p < buf + size)
12150 {
12151 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
12152 Elf_Internal_Note in;
12153
12154 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
12155 return false;
12156
12157 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
12158
12159 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
12160 in.namedata = xnp->name;
12161 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
12162 return false;
12163
12164 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
12165 in.descdata = p + ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in.namesz, align);
12166 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
12167 if (in.descsz != 0
12168 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
12169 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
12170 return false;
12171
12172 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
12173 {
12174 default:
12175 return true;
12176
12177 case bfd_core:
12178 {
12179 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
12180 struct
12181 {
12182 const char * string;
12183 size_t len;
12184 bool (*func) (bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
12185 }
12186 grokers[] =
12187 {
12188 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
12189 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
12190 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
12191 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
12192 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
12193 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note),
12194 GROKER_ELEMENT ("GNU", elfobj_grok_gnu_note)
12195 };
12196 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
12197 int i;
12198
12199 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
12200 {
12201 if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
12202 && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
12203 grokers[i].len) == 0)
12204 {
12205 if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
12206 return false;
12207 break;
12208 }
12209 }
12210 break;
12211 }
12212
12213 case bfd_object:
12214 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
12215 {
12216 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
12217 return false;
12218 }
12219 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
12220 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
12221 {
12222 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
12223 return false;
12224 }
12225 break;
12226 }
12227
12228 p += ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in.namesz, in.descsz, align);
12229 }
12230
12231 return true;
12232 }
12233
12234 bool
12235 elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size,
12236 size_t align)
12237 {
12238 char *buf;
12239
12240 if (size == 0 || (size + 1) == 0)
12241 return true;
12242
12243 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
12244 return false;
12245
12246 buf = (char *) _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd, size + 1, size);
12247 if (buf == NULL)
12248 return false;
12249
12250 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
12251 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
12252 buf[size] = 0;
12253
12254 if (!elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset, align))
12255 {
12256 free (buf);
12257 return false;
12258 }
12259
12260 free (buf);
12261 return true;
12262 }
12263 \f
12264 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
12265
12266 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
12267 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
12268 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
12269
12270 long
12271 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
12272 {
12273 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
12274 {
12275 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
12276 return -1;
12277 }
12278
12279 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
12280 }
12281
12282 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
12283 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
12284 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
12285 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
12286
12287 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
12288 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
12289
12290 int
12291 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
12292 {
12293 int num_phdrs;
12294
12295 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
12296 {
12297 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
12298 return -1;
12299 }
12300
12301 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
12302 if (num_phdrs != 0)
12303 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
12304 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
12305
12306 return num_phdrs;
12307 }
12308
12309 enum elf_reloc_type_class
12310 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12311 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12312 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12313 {
12314 return reloc_class_normal;
12315 }
12316
12317 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
12318 relocation against a local symbol. */
12319
12320 bfd_vma
12321 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
12322 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
12323 asection **psec,
12324 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
12325 {
12326 asection *sec = *psec;
12327 bfd_vma relocation;
12328
12329 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
12330 + sec->output_offset
12331 + sym->st_value);
12332 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
12333 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
12334 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
12335 {
12336 rel->r_addend =
12337 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
12338 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
12339 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
12340 if (sec != *psec)
12341 {
12342 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
12343 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
12344 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
12345 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
12346 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
12347 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
12348 sec->kept_section = *psec;
12349 sec = *psec;
12350 }
12351 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
12352 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
12353 }
12354 return relocation;
12355 }
12356
12357 bfd_vma
12358 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
12359 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
12360 asection **psec,
12361 bfd_vma addend)
12362 {
12363 asection *sec = *psec;
12364
12365 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
12366 return sym->st_value + addend;
12367
12368 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
12369 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
12370 sym->st_value + addend);
12371 }
12372
12373 /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
12374 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
12375 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
12376 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
12377 byte may be. */
12378
12379 bfd_vma
12380 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
12381 struct bfd_link_info *info,
12382 asection *sec,
12383 bfd_vma offset)
12384 {
12385 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
12386 {
12387 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
12388 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
12389 offset);
12390 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
12391 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
12392
12393 default:
12394 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
12395 {
12396 /* Reverse the offset. */
12397 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12398 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
12399
12400 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
12401 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
12402 offset = ((sec->size - address_size)
12403 / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) - offset);
12404 }
12405 return offset;
12406 }
12407 }
12408 \f
12409 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
12410 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
12411 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
12412 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
12413 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
12414 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
12415
12416 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
12417 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
12418 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
12419 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
12420 the remote memory. */
12421
12422 bfd *
12423 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
12424 (bfd *templ,
12425 bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
12426 bfd_size_type size,
12427 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
12428 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
12429 {
12430 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
12431 (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
12432 }
12433 \f
12434 long
12435 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
12436 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12437 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12438 long dynsymcount,
12439 asymbol **dynsyms,
12440 asymbol **ret)
12441 {
12442 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12443 asection *relplt;
12444 asymbol *s;
12445 const char *relplt_name;
12446 bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool);
12447 arelent *p;
12448 long count, i, n;
12449 size_t size;
12450 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
12451 char *names;
12452 asection *plt;
12453
12454 *ret = NULL;
12455
12456 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
12457 return 0;
12458
12459 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
12460 return 0;
12461
12462 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
12463 return 0;
12464
12465 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
12466 if (relplt_name == NULL)
12467 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
12468 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
12469 if (relplt == NULL)
12470 return 0;
12471
12472 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
12473 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
12474 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
12475 return 0;
12476
12477 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
12478 if (plt == NULL)
12479 return 0;
12480
12481 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
12482 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, true))
12483 return -1;
12484
12485 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
12486 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
12487 p = relplt->relocation;
12488 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
12489 {
12490 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
12491 if (p->addend != 0)
12492 {
12493 #ifdef BFD64
12494 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
12495 #else
12496 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
12497 #endif
12498 }
12499 }
12500
12501 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
12502 if (s == NULL)
12503 return -1;
12504
12505 names = (char *) (s + count);
12506 p = relplt->relocation;
12507 n = 0;
12508 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
12509 {
12510 size_t len;
12511 bfd_vma addr;
12512
12513 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
12514 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
12515 continue;
12516
12517 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
12518 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
12519 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
12520 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
12521 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
12522 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
12523 s->section = plt;
12524 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
12525 s->name = names;
12526 s->udata.p = NULL;
12527 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
12528 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
12529 names += len;
12530 if (p->addend != 0)
12531 {
12532 char buf[30], *a;
12533
12534 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
12535 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
12536 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
12537 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
12538 ;
12539 len = strlen (a);
12540 memcpy (names, a, len);
12541 names += len;
12542 }
12543 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
12544 names += sizeof ("@plt");
12545 ++s, ++n;
12546 }
12547
12548 return n;
12549 }
12550
12551 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
12552 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
12553 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
12554 static const asymbol lcomm_sym
12555 = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section);
12556 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
12557 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, &lcomm_sym,
12558 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
12559
12560 bool
12561 _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
12562 {
12563 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
12564
12565 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
12566
12567 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE)
12568 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
12569
12570 /* Set the osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains
12571 SHF_GNU_MBIND or SHF_GNU_RETAIN sections or symbols of STT_GNU_IFUNC type
12572 or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
12573 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi != 0)
12574 {
12575 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE)
12576 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
12577 else if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] != ELFOSABI_GNU
12578 && i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] != ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
12579 {
12580 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind)
12581 _bfd_error_handler (_("GNU_MBIND section is supported only by GNU "
12582 "and FreeBSD targets"));
12583 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_ifunc)
12584 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol type STT_GNU_IFUNC is supported "
12585 "only by GNU and FreeBSD targets"));
12586 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_unique)
12587 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol binding STB_GNU_UNIQUE is supported "
12588 "only by GNU and FreeBSD targets"));
12589 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_retain)
12590 _bfd_error_handler (_("GNU_RETAIN section is supported "
12591 "only by GNU and FreeBSD targets"));
12592 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry);
12593 return false;
12594 }
12595 }
12596 return true;
12597 }
12598
12599
12600 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
12601 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
12602 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
12603
12604 bool
12605 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
12606 {
12607 return (type == STT_FUNC
12608 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
12609 }
12610
12611 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
12612 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
12613 otherwise return zero. */
12614
12615 bfd_size_type
12616 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
12617 bfd_vma *code_off)
12618 {
12619 bfd_size_type size;
12620
12621 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
12622 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
12623 || sym->section != sec)
12624 return 0;
12625
12626 *code_off = sym->value;
12627 size = 0;
12628 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
12629 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
12630 if (size == 0)
12631 size = 1;
12632 return size;
12633 }
12634
12635 /* Set to non-zero to enable some debug messages. */
12636 #define DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS 0
12637
12638 /* An internal-to-the-bfd-library only section type
12639 used to indicate a cached secondary reloc section. */
12640 #define SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC (SHT_LOOS + SHT_RELA)
12641
12642 /* Create a BFD section to hold a secondary reloc section. */
12643
12644 bool
12645 _bfd_elf_init_secondary_reloc_section (bfd * abfd,
12646 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
12647 const char * name,
12648 unsigned int shindex)
12649 {
12650 /* We only support RELA secondary relocs. */
12651 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA)
12652 return false;
12653
12654 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12655 fprintf (stderr, "secondary reloc section %s encountered\n", name);
12656 #endif
12657 hdr->sh_type = SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC;
12658 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
12659 }
12660
12661 /* Read in any secondary relocs associated with SEC. */
12662
12663 bool
12664 _bfd_elf_slurp_secondary_reloc_section (bfd * abfd,
12665 asection * sec,
12666 asymbol ** symbols,
12667 bool dynamic)
12668 {
12669 const struct elf_backend_data * const ebd = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12670 asection * relsec;
12671 bool result = true;
12672 bfd_vma (*r_sym) (bfd_vma);
12673
12674 #if BFD_DEFAULT_TARGET_SIZE > 32
12675 if (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) != 32)
12676 r_sym = elf64_r_sym;
12677 else
12678 #endif
12679 r_sym = elf32_r_sym;
12680
12681 /* Discover if there are any secondary reloc sections
12682 associated with SEC. */
12683 for (relsec = abfd->sections; relsec != NULL; relsec = relsec->next)
12684 {
12685 Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr = & elf_section_data (relsec)->this_hdr;
12686
12687 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC
12688 && hdr->sh_info == (unsigned) elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx
12689 && (hdr->sh_entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rel
12690 || hdr->sh_entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rela))
12691 {
12692 bfd_byte * native_relocs;
12693 bfd_byte * native_reloc;
12694 arelent * internal_relocs;
12695 arelent * internal_reloc;
12696 unsigned int i;
12697 unsigned int entsize;
12698 unsigned int symcount;
12699 unsigned int reloc_count;
12700 size_t amt;
12701
12702 if (ebd->elf_info_to_howto == NULL)
12703 return false;
12704
12705 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12706 fprintf (stderr, "read secondary relocs for %s from %s\n",
12707 sec->name, relsec->name);
12708 #endif
12709 entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
12710
12711 native_relocs = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
12712 if (native_relocs == NULL)
12713 {
12714 result = false;
12715 continue;
12716 }
12717
12718 reloc_count = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
12719 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (reloc_count, sizeof (arelent), & amt))
12720 {
12721 free (native_relocs);
12722 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
12723 result = false;
12724 continue;
12725 }
12726
12727 internal_relocs = (arelent *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
12728 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
12729 {
12730 free (native_relocs);
12731 result = false;
12732 continue;
12733 }
12734
12735 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
12736 || (bfd_bread (native_relocs, hdr->sh_size, abfd)
12737 != hdr->sh_size))
12738 {
12739 free (native_relocs);
12740 /* The internal_relocs will be freed when
12741 the memory for the bfd is released. */
12742 result = false;
12743 continue;
12744 }
12745
12746 if (dynamic)
12747 symcount = bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd);
12748 else
12749 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
12750
12751 for (i = 0, internal_reloc = internal_relocs,
12752 native_reloc = native_relocs;
12753 i < reloc_count;
12754 i++, internal_reloc++, native_reloc += entsize)
12755 {
12756 bool res;
12757 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
12758
12759 if (entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rel)
12760 ebd->s->swap_reloc_in (abfd, native_reloc, & rela);
12761 else /* entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rela */
12762 ebd->s->swap_reloca_in (abfd, native_reloc, & rela);
12763
12764 /* The address of an ELF reloc is section relative for an object
12765 file, and absolute for an executable file or shared library.
12766 The address of a normal BFD reloc is always section relative,
12767 and the address of a dynamic reloc is absolute.. */
12768 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0)
12769 internal_reloc->address = rela.r_offset;
12770 else
12771 internal_reloc->address = rela.r_offset - sec->vma;
12772
12773 if (r_sym (rela.r_info) == STN_UNDEF)
12774 {
12775 /* FIXME: This and the error case below mean that we
12776 have a symbol on relocs that is not elf_symbol_type. */
12777 internal_reloc->sym_ptr_ptr =
12778 bfd_abs_section_ptr->symbol_ptr_ptr;
12779 }
12780 else if (r_sym (rela.r_info) > symcount)
12781 {
12782 _bfd_error_handler
12783 /* xgettext:c-format */
12784 (_("%pB(%pA): relocation %d has invalid symbol index %ld"),
12785 abfd, sec, i, (long) r_sym (rela.r_info));
12786 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12787 internal_reloc->sym_ptr_ptr =
12788 bfd_abs_section_ptr->symbol_ptr_ptr;
12789 result = false;
12790 }
12791 else
12792 {
12793 asymbol **ps;
12794
12795 ps = symbols + r_sym (rela.r_info) - 1;
12796 internal_reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = ps;
12797 /* Make sure that this symbol is not removed by strip. */
12798 (*ps)->flags |= BSF_KEEP;
12799 }
12800
12801 internal_reloc->addend = rela.r_addend;
12802
12803 res = ebd->elf_info_to_howto (abfd, internal_reloc, & rela);
12804 if (! res || internal_reloc->howto == NULL)
12805 {
12806 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12807 fprintf (stderr, "there is no howto associated with reloc %lx\n",
12808 rela.r_info);
12809 #endif
12810 result = false;
12811 }
12812 }
12813
12814 free (native_relocs);
12815 /* Store the internal relocs. */
12816 elf_section_data (relsec)->sec_info = internal_relocs;
12817 }
12818 }
12819
12820 return result;
12821 }
12822
12823 /* Set the ELF section header fields of an output secondary reloc section. */
12824
12825 bool
12826 _bfd_elf_copy_special_section_fields (const bfd * ibfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12827 bfd * obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12828 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * isection,
12829 Elf_Internal_Shdr * osection)
12830 {
12831 asection * isec;
12832 asection * osec;
12833 struct bfd_elf_section_data * esd;
12834
12835 if (isection == NULL)
12836 return false;
12837
12838 if (isection->sh_type != SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC)
12839 return true;
12840
12841 isec = isection->bfd_section;
12842 if (isec == NULL)
12843 return false;
12844
12845 osec = osection->bfd_section;
12846 if (osec == NULL)
12847 return false;
12848
12849 esd = elf_section_data (osec);
12850 BFD_ASSERT (esd->sec_info == NULL);
12851 esd->sec_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
12852 osection->sh_type = SHT_RELA;
12853 osection->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (obfd);
12854 if (osection->sh_link == 0)
12855 {
12856 /* There is no symbol table - we are hosed... */
12857 _bfd_error_handler
12858 /* xgettext:c-format */
12859 (_("%pB(%pA): link section cannot be set because the output file does not have a symbol table"),
12860 obfd, osec);
12861 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12862 return false;
12863 }
12864
12865 /* Find the output section that corresponds to the isection's sh_info link. */
12866 if (isection->sh_info == 0
12867 || isection->sh_info >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
12868 {
12869 _bfd_error_handler
12870 /* xgettext:c-format */
12871 (_("%pB(%pA): info section index is invalid"),
12872 obfd, osec);
12873 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12874 return false;
12875 }
12876
12877 isection = elf_elfsections (ibfd)[isection->sh_info];
12878
12879 if (isection == NULL
12880 || isection->bfd_section == NULL
12881 || isection->bfd_section->output_section == NULL)
12882 {
12883 _bfd_error_handler
12884 /* xgettext:c-format */
12885 (_("%pB(%pA): info section index cannot be set because the section is not in the output"),
12886 obfd, osec);
12887 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12888 return false;
12889 }
12890
12891 esd = elf_section_data (isection->bfd_section->output_section);
12892 BFD_ASSERT (esd != NULL);
12893 osection->sh_info = esd->this_idx;
12894 esd->has_secondary_relocs = true;
12895 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12896 fprintf (stderr, "update header of %s, sh_link = %u, sh_info = %u\n",
12897 osec->name, osection->sh_link, osection->sh_info);
12898 fprintf (stderr, "mark section %s as having secondary relocs\n",
12899 bfd_section_name (isection->bfd_section->output_section));
12900 #endif
12901
12902 return true;
12903 }
12904
12905 /* Write out a secondary reloc section.
12906
12907 FIXME: Currently this function can result in a serious performance penalty
12908 for files with secondary relocs and lots of sections. The proper way to
12909 fix this is for _bfd_elf_copy_special_section_fields() to chain secondary
12910 relocs together and then to have this function just walk that chain. */
12911
12912 bool
12913 _bfd_elf_write_secondary_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
12914 {
12915 const struct elf_backend_data * const ebd = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12916 bfd_vma addr_offset;
12917 asection * relsec;
12918 bfd_vma (*r_info) (bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
12919 bool result = true;
12920
12921 if (sec == NULL)
12922 return false;
12923
12924 #if BFD_DEFAULT_TARGET_SIZE > 32
12925 if (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) != 32)
12926 r_info = elf64_r_info;
12927 else
12928 #endif
12929 r_info = elf32_r_info;
12930
12931 /* The address of an ELF reloc is section relative for an object
12932 file, and absolute for an executable file or shared library.
12933 The address of a BFD reloc is always section relative. */
12934 addr_offset = 0;
12935 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) != 0)
12936 addr_offset = sec->vma;
12937
12938 /* Discover if there are any secondary reloc sections
12939 associated with SEC. */
12940 for (relsec = abfd->sections; relsec != NULL; relsec = relsec->next)
12941 {
12942 const struct bfd_elf_section_data * const esd = elf_section_data (relsec);
12943 Elf_Internal_Shdr * const hdr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) & esd->this_hdr;
12944
12945 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
12946 && hdr->sh_info == (unsigned) elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx)
12947 {
12948 asymbol * last_sym;
12949 int last_sym_idx;
12950 unsigned int reloc_count;
12951 unsigned int idx;
12952 unsigned int entsize;
12953 arelent * src_irel;
12954 bfd_byte * dst_rela;
12955
12956 if (hdr->contents != NULL)
12957 {
12958 _bfd_error_handler
12959 /* xgettext:c-format */
12960 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section processed twice"),
12961 abfd, relsec);
12962 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12963 result = false;
12964 continue;
12965 }
12966
12967 entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
12968 if (entsize == 0)
12969 {
12970 _bfd_error_handler
12971 /* xgettext:c-format */
12972 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section has zero sized entries"),
12973 abfd, relsec);
12974 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12975 result = false;
12976 continue;
12977 }
12978 else if (entsize != ebd->s->sizeof_rel
12979 && entsize != ebd->s->sizeof_rela)
12980 {
12981 _bfd_error_handler
12982 /* xgettext:c-format */
12983 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section has non-standard sized entries"),
12984 abfd, relsec);
12985 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12986 result = false;
12987 continue;
12988 }
12989
12990 reloc_count = hdr->sh_size / entsize;
12991 if (reloc_count <= 0)
12992 {
12993 _bfd_error_handler
12994 /* xgettext:c-format */
12995 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section is empty!"),
12996 abfd, relsec);
12997 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12998 result = false;
12999 continue;
13000 }
13001
13002 hdr->contents = bfd_alloc (abfd, hdr->sh_size);
13003 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
13004 continue;
13005
13006 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
13007 fprintf (stderr, "write %u secondary relocs for %s from %s\n",
13008 reloc_count, sec->name, relsec->name);
13009 #endif
13010 last_sym = NULL;
13011 last_sym_idx = 0;
13012 dst_rela = hdr->contents;
13013 src_irel = (arelent *) esd->sec_info;
13014 if (src_irel == NULL)
13015 {
13016 _bfd_error_handler
13017 /* xgettext:c-format */
13018 (_("%pB(%pA): error: internal relocs missing for secondary reloc section"),
13019 abfd, relsec);
13020 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13021 result = false;
13022 continue;
13023 }
13024
13025 for (idx = 0; idx < reloc_count; idx++, dst_rela += entsize)
13026 {
13027 Elf_Internal_Rela src_rela;
13028 arelent *ptr;
13029 asymbol *sym;
13030 int n;
13031
13032 ptr = src_irel + idx;
13033 if (ptr == NULL)
13034 {
13035 _bfd_error_handler
13036 /* xgettext:c-format */
13037 (_("%pB(%pA): error: reloc table entry %u is empty"),
13038 abfd, relsec, idx);
13039 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13040 result = false;
13041 break;
13042 }
13043
13044 if (ptr->sym_ptr_ptr == NULL)
13045 {
13046 /* FIXME: Is this an error ? */
13047 n = 0;
13048 }
13049 else
13050 {
13051 sym = *ptr->sym_ptr_ptr;
13052
13053 if (sym == last_sym)
13054 n = last_sym_idx;
13055 else
13056 {
13057 n = _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (abfd, & sym);
13058 if (n < 0)
13059 {
13060 _bfd_error_handler
13061 /* xgettext:c-format */
13062 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u references a missing symbol"),
13063 abfd, relsec, idx);
13064 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13065 result = false;
13066 n = 0;
13067 }
13068
13069 last_sym = sym;
13070 last_sym_idx = n;
13071 }
13072
13073 if (sym->the_bfd != NULL
13074 && sym->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec
13075 && ! _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (abfd, ptr))
13076 {
13077 _bfd_error_handler
13078 /* xgettext:c-format */
13079 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u references a deleted symbol"),
13080 abfd, relsec, idx);
13081 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13082 result = false;
13083 n = 0;
13084 }
13085 }
13086
13087 src_rela.r_offset = ptr->address + addr_offset;
13088 if (ptr->howto == NULL)
13089 {
13090 _bfd_error_handler
13091 /* xgettext:c-format */
13092 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u is of an unknown type"),
13093 abfd, relsec, idx);
13094 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13095 result = false;
13096 src_rela.r_info = r_info (0, 0);
13097 }
13098 else
13099 src_rela.r_info = r_info (n, ptr->howto->type);
13100 src_rela.r_addend = ptr->addend;
13101
13102 if (entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rel)
13103 ebd->s->swap_reloc_out (abfd, &src_rela, dst_rela);
13104 else /* entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rela */
13105 ebd->s->swap_reloca_out (abfd, &src_rela, dst_rela);
13106 }
13107 }
13108 }
13109
13110 return result;
13111 }